Modul:Citation/CS1: Perbedaan antara revisi

Loncat ke navigasi Loncat ke pencarian
56.659 bita dihapus ,  1 tahun yang lalu
←Membuat halaman berisi ' local cs1 ={}; --[[--------------------------< F O R W A R D D E C L A R A T I O N S >-------------------------------------- ]] local dates, year_date_check, reformat_dates, date_hyphen_to_dash, -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation date_name_xlate local is_set, in_array, substitute, error_comment, set_error, select_one, -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities add_maint_cat, wrap_style, safe_for_italics, is_wikilink, make_wikilink;...'
dw>Trappist the monk
(fix {{cs1 config}} support for |display-translators=;)
(←Membuat halaman berisi ' local cs1 ={}; --[[--------------------------< F O R W A R D D E C L A R A T I O N S >-------------------------------------- ]] local dates, year_date_check, reformat_dates, date_hyphen_to_dash, -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation date_name_xlate local is_set, in_array, substitute, error_comment, set_error, select_one, -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities add_maint_cat, wrap_style, safe_for_italics, is_wikilink, make_wikilink;...')
Baris 1: Baris 1:
require ('strict');
 
local cs1 ={};


--[[--------------------------< F O R W A R D  D E C L A R A T I O N S >--------------------------------------
--[[--------------------------< F O R W A R D  D E C L A R A T I O N S >--------------------------------------
]]
local dates, year_date_check, reformat_dates, date_hyphen_to_dash, -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation
date_name_xlate


each of these counts against the Lua upvalue limit
local is_set, in_array, substitute, error_comment, set_error, select_one, -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
add_maint_cat, wrap_style, safe_for_italics, is_wikilink, make_wikilink;


]]
local z ={}; -- tables in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities


local validation; -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation
local extract_ids, extract_id_access_levels, build_id_list, is_embargoed; -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Identifiers


local utilities; -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
local make_coins_title, get_coins_pages, COinS; -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/COinS
local z = {}; -- table of tables in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities


local identifiers; -- functions and tables in Module:Citation/CS1/Identifiers
local metadata; -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/COinS
local cfg = {}; -- table of configuration tables that are defined in Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration
local cfg = {}; -- table of configuration tables that are defined in Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration
local whitelist = {}; -- table of tables listing valid template parameter names; defined in Module:Citation/CS1/Whitelist
local whitelist = {}; -- table of tables listing valid template parameter names; defined in Module:Citation/CS1/Whitelist




--[[------------------< P A G E  S C O P E  V A R I A B L E S >---------------
--[[--------------------------< P A G E  S C O P E  V A R I A B L E S >--------------------------------------


declare variables here that have page-wide scope that are not brought in from
delare variables here that have page-wide scope that are not brought in from other modules; thatare created here
other modules; that are created here and used here
and used here


]]
]]


local added_deprecated_cat; -- Boolean flag so that the category is added only once
local added_deprecated_cat; -- boolean flag so that the category is added only once
local added_vanc_errs; -- Boolean flag so we only emit one Vancouver error / category
local added_prop_cats = {}; -- list of property categories that have been added to z.properties_cats
local added_generic_name_errs; -- Boolean flag so we only emit one generic name error / category and stop testing names once an error is encountered
local added_vanc_errs; -- boolean flag so we only emit one Vancouver error / category
 
local Frame; -- holds the module's frame table
local Frame; -- holds the module's frame table
local is_preview_mode; -- true when article is in preview mode; false when using 'Preview page with this template' (previewing the module)
local is_sandbox; -- true when using sandbox modules to render citation




Baris 47: Baris 49:
local i = 1;
local i = 1;
while i <= count do -- loop through all items in list
while i <= count do -- loop through all items in list
if utilities.is_set( list[i] ) then
if is_set( list[i] ) then
return list[i]; -- return the first set list member
return list[i]; -- return the first set list member
end
end
i = i + 1; -- point to next
i = i + 1; -- point to next
end
end
--[[--------------------------< A D D _ P R O P _ C A T >--------------------------------------------------------
Adds a category to z.properties_cats using names from the configuration file with additional text if any.
foreign_lang_source and foreign_lang_source_2 keys have a language code appended to them so that multiple languages
may be categorized but multiples of the same language are not categorized.
added_prop_cats is a table declared in page scope variables above
]]
local function add_prop_cat (key, arguments)
if not added_prop_cats [key] then
added_prop_cats [key] = true; -- note that we've added this category
key = key:gsub ('(foreign_lang_source_?2?)%a%a%a?', '%1'); -- strip lang code from keyname
table.insert( z.properties_cats, substitute (cfg.prop_cats [key], arguments)); -- make name then add to table
end
end
end
end
Baris 60: Baris 82:
To prevent duplication, added_vanc_errs is nil until an error message is emitted.
To prevent duplication, added_vanc_errs is nil until an error message is emitted.


added_vanc_errs is a Boolean declared in page scope variables above
added_vanc_errs is a boolean declared in page scope variables above


]]
]]


local function add_vanc_error (source, position)
local function add_vanc_error (source)
if added_vanc_errs then return end
if not added_vanc_errs then
added_vanc_errs = true; -- note that we've added this category
added_vanc_errs = true; -- note that we've added this category
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'vancouver', {source}, true ) } );
utilities.set_message ('err_vancouver', {source, position});
end
end
end


Baris 74: Baris 96:
--[[--------------------------< I S _ S C H E M E >------------------------------------------------------------
--[[--------------------------< I S _ S C H E M E >------------------------------------------------------------


does this thing that purports to be a URI scheme seem to be a valid scheme?  The scheme is checked to see if it
does this thing that purports to be a uri scheme seem to be a valid scheme?  The scheme is checked to see if it
is in agreement with http://tools.ietf.org/html/std66#section-3.1 which says:
is in agreement with http://tools.ietf.org/html/std66#section-3.1 which says:
Scheme names consist of a sequence of characters beginning with a
Scheme names consist of a sequence of characters beginning with a
Baris 97: Baris 119:
Single character names are generally reserved; see https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-dnsind-iana-dns-01#page-15;
Single character names are generally reserved; see https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-dnsind-iana-dns-01#page-15;
see also [[Single-letter second-level domain]]
see also [[Single-letter second-level domain]]
list of TLDs: https://www.iana.org/domains/root/db
list of tlds: https://www.iana.org/domains/root/db


RFC 952 (modified by RFC 1123) requires the first and last character of a hostname to be a letter or a digit.  Between
rfc952 (modified by rfc 1123) requires the first and last character of a hostname to be a letter or a digit.  Between
the first and last characters the name may use letters, digits, and the hyphen.
the first and last characters the name may use letters, digits, and the hyphen.


Also allowed are IPv4 addresses. IPv6 not supported
Also allowed are IPv4 addresses. IPv6 not supported


domain is expected to be stripped of any path so that the last character in the last character of the TLD.  tld
domain is expected to be stripped of any path so that the last character in the last character of the tld.  tld
is two or more alpha characters.  Any preceding '//' (from splitting a URL with a scheme) will be stripped
is two or more alpha characters.  Any preceding '//' (from splitting a url with a scheme) will be stripped
here.  Perhaps not necessary but retained in case it is necessary for IPv4 dot decimal.
here.  Perhaps not necessary but retained incase it is necessary for IPv4 dot decimal.


There are several tests:
There are several tests:
the first character of the whole domain name including subdomains must be a letter or a digit
the first character of the whole domain name including subdomains must be a letter or a digit
internationalized domain name (ASCII characters with .xn-- ASCII Compatible Encoding (ACE) prefix xn-- in the TLD) see https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3490
internationalized domain name (ascii characters with .xn-- ASCII Compatible Encoding (ACE) prefix xn-- in the tld) see https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3490
single-letter/digit second-level domains in the .org, .cash, and .today TLDs
single-letter/digit second-level domains in the .org and .cash TLDs
q, x, and z SL domains in the .com TLD
q, x, and z SL domains in the .com TLD
i and q SL domains in the .net TLD
i and q SL domains in the .net TLD
Baris 119: Baris 141:
IPv4 dot-decimal address format; TLD not allowed
IPv4 dot-decimal address format; TLD not allowed


returns true if domain appears to be a proper name and TLD or IPv4 address, else false
returns true if domain appears to be a proper name and tld or IPv4 address, else false


]=]
]=]
Baris 130: Baris 152:
domain = domain:gsub ('^//', ''); -- strip '//' from domain name if present; done here so we only have to do it once
domain = domain:gsub ('^//', ''); -- strip '//' from domain name if present; done here so we only have to do it once
if not domain:match ('^[%w]') then -- first character must be letter or digit
if not domain:match ('^[%a%d]') then -- first character must be letter or digit
return false;
return false;
end
end
 
-- Do most common case first
if domain:match ('^%a+:') then -- hack to detect things that look like s:Page:Title where Page: is namespace at Wikisource
if domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d][%a%d%-]+[%a%d]%.%a%a+$') then -- three or more character hostname.hostname or hostname.tld
return true;
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d][%a%d%-]+[%a%d]%.xn%-%-[%a%d]+$') then -- internationalized domain name with ACE prefix
return true;
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d]%.cash$') then -- one character/digit .cash hostname
return true;
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d]%.org$') then -- one character/digit .org hostname
return true;
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a][qxz]%.com$') then -- assigned one character .com hostname (x.com times out 2015-12-10)
return true;
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a][iq]%.net$') then -- assigned one character .net hostname (q.net registered but not active 2015-12-10)
return true;
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d]%.%a%a$') then -- one character hostname and cctld (2 chars)
return true;
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d][%a%d]%.%a%a+$') then -- two character hostname and tld
return true;
elseif domain:match ('^%d%d?%d?%.%d%d?%d?%.%d%d?%d?%.%d%d?%d?') then -- IPv4 address
return true;
else
return false;
return false;
end
end
end


local patterns = { -- patterns that look like URLs
'%f[%w][%w][%w%-]+[%w]%.%a%a+$', -- three or more character hostname.hostname or hostname.tld
'%f[%w][%w][%w%-]+[%w]%.xn%-%-[%w]+$', -- internationalized domain name with ACE prefix
'%f[%a][qxz]%.com$', -- assigned one character .com hostname (x.com times out 2015-12-10)
'%f[%a][iq]%.net$', -- assigned one character .net hostname (q.net registered but not active 2015-12-10)
'%f[%w][%w]%.%a%a$', -- one character hostname and ccTLD (2 chars)
'%f[%w][%w][%w]%.%a%a+$', -- two character hostname and TLD
'^%d%d?%d?%.%d%d?%d?%.%d%d?%d?%.%d%d?%d?', -- IPv4 address
}


for _, pattern in ipairs (patterns) do -- loop through the patterns list
--[[--------------------------< I S _ U R L >------------------------------------------------------------------
if domain:match (pattern) then
return true; -- if a match then we think that this thing that purports to be a URL is a URL
end
end
 
for _, d in ipairs (cfg.single_letter_2nd_lvl_domains_t) do -- look for single letter second level domain names for these top level domains
if domain:match ('%f[%w][%w]%.' .. d) then
return true
end
end
return false; -- no matches, we don't know what this thing is
end
 
 
--[[--------------------------< I S _ U R L >------------------------------------------------------------------


returns true if the scheme and domain parts of a URL appear to be a valid URL; else false.
returns true if the scheme and domain parts of a url appear to be a valid url; else false.


This function is the last step in the validation process.  This function is separate because there are cases that
This function is the last step in the validation process.  This function is separate because there are cases that
Baris 174: Baris 191:


local function is_url (scheme, domain)
local function is_url (scheme, domain)
if utilities.is_set (scheme) then -- if scheme is set check it and domain
if is_set (scheme) then -- if scheme is set check it and domain
return is_scheme (scheme) and is_domain_name (domain);
return is_scheme (scheme) and is_domain_name (domain);
else
else
return is_domain_name (domain); -- scheme not set when URL is protocol-relative
return is_domain_name (domain); -- scheme not set when url is protocol relative
end
end
end
end
Baris 184: Baris 201:
--[[--------------------------< S P L I T _ U R L >------------------------------------------------------------
--[[--------------------------< S P L I T _ U R L >------------------------------------------------------------


Split a URL into a scheme, authority indicator, and domain.
Split a url into a scheme, authority indicator, and domain.


First remove Fully Qualified Domain Name terminator (a dot following TLD) (if any) and any path(/), query(?) or fragment(#).
First remove Fully Qualified Domain Name terminator (a dot following tld) (if any) and any path(/), query(?) or fragment(#).


If protocol-relative URL, return nil scheme and domain else return nil for both scheme and domain.
If protocol relative url, return nil scheme and domain else return nil for both scheme and domain.


When not protocol-relative, get scheme, authority indicator, and domain.  If there is an authority indicator (one
When not protocol relative, get scheme, authority indicator, and domain.  If there is an authority indicator (one
or more '/' characters immediately following the scheme's colon), make sure that there are only 2.
or more '/' characters immediately following the scheme's colon), make sure that there are only 2.
Any URL that does not have news: scheme must have authority indicator (//).  TODO: are there other common schemes
like news: that don't use authority indicator?


Strip off any port and path;
Strip off any port and path;
Baris 205: Baris 219:
url_str = url_str:gsub ('([%a%d])%.?[/%?#].*$', '%1'); -- strip FQDN terminator and path(/), query(?), fragment (#) (the capture prevents false replacement of '//')
url_str = url_str:gsub ('([%a%d])%.?[/%?#].*$', '%1'); -- strip FQDN terminator and path(/), query(?), fragment (#) (the capture prevents false replacement of '//')


if url_str:match ('^//%S*') then -- if there is what appears to be a protocol-relative URL
if url_str:match ('^//%S*') then -- if there is what appears to be a protocol relative url
domain = url_str:match ('^//(%S*)')
domain = url_str:match ('^//(%S*)')
elseif url_str:match ('%S-:/*%S+') then -- if there is what appears to be a scheme, optional authority indicator, and domain name
elseif url_str:match ('%S-:/*%S+') then -- if there is what appears to be a scheme, optional authority indicator, and domain name
scheme, authority, domain = url_str:match ('(%S-:)(/*)(%S+)'); -- extract the scheme, authority indicator, and domain portions
scheme, authority, domain = url_str:match ('(%S-:)(/*)(%S+)'); -- extract the scheme, authority indicator, and domain portions
if utilities.is_set (authority) then
authority = authority:gsub ('//', '', 1); -- replace place 1 pair of '/' with nothing;
authority = authority:gsub ('//', '', 1); -- replace place 1 pair of '/' with nothing;
if is_set(authority) then -- if anything left (1 or 3+ '/' where authority should be) then
if utilities.is_set(authority) then -- if anything left (1 or 3+ '/' where authority should be) then
return scheme; -- return scheme only making domain nil which will cause an error message
return scheme; -- return scheme only making domain nil which will cause an error message
end
else
if not scheme:match ('^news:') then -- except for news:..., MediaWiki won't link URLs that do not have authority indicator; TODO: a better way to do this test?
return scheme; -- return scheme only making domain nil which will cause an error message
end
end
end
domain = domain:gsub ('(%a):%d+', '%1'); -- strip port number if present
domain = domain:gsub ('(%a):%d+', '%1'); -- strip port number if present
Baris 228: Baris 236:
--[[--------------------------< L I N K _ P A R A M _ O K >---------------------------------------------------
--[[--------------------------< L I N K _ P A R A M _ O K >---------------------------------------------------


checks the content of |title-link=, |series-link=, |author-link=, etc. for properly formatted content: no wikilinks, no URLs
checks the content of |title-link=, |series-link=, |author-link= etc for properly formatted content: no wikilinks, no urls


Link parameters are to hold the title of a Wikipedia article, so none of the WP:TITLESPECIALCHARACTERS are allowed:
Link parameters are to hold the title of a wikipedia article so none of the WP:TITLESPECIALCHARACTERS are allowed:
# < > [ ] | { } _
# < > [ ] | { } _
except the underscore which is used as a space in wiki URLs and # which is used for section links
except the underscore which is used as a space in wiki urls and # which is used for section links


returns false when the value contains any of these characters.
returns false when the value contains any of these characters.


When there are no illegal characters, this function returns TRUE if value DOES NOT appear to be a valid URL (the
When there are no illegal characters, this function returns TRUE if value DOES NOT appear to be a valid url (the
|<param>-link= parameter is ok); else false when value appears to be a valid URL (the |<param>-link= parameter is NOT ok).
|<param>-link= parameter is ok); else false when value appears to be a valid url (the |<param>-link= parameter is NOT ok).


]]
]]
Baris 247: Baris 255:
end
end


scheme, domain = split_url (value); -- get scheme or nil and domain or nil from URL;  
scheme, domain = split_url (value); -- get scheme or nil and domain or nil from url;  
return not is_url (scheme, domain); -- return true if value DOES NOT appear to be a valid URL
return not is_url (scheme, domain); -- return true if value DOES NOT appear to be a valid url
end
end


Baris 256: Baris 264:
Use link_param_ok() to validate |<param>-link= value and its matching |<title>= value.
Use link_param_ok() to validate |<param>-link= value and its matching |<title>= value.


|<title>= may be wiki-linked but not when |<param>-link= has a value.  This function emits an error message when
|<title>= may be wikilinked but not when |<param>-link= has a value.  This function emits an error message when
that condition exists
that condition exists
check <link> for inter-language interwiki-link prefix.  prefix must be a MediaWiki-recognized language
code and must begin with a colon.


]]
]]


local function link_title_ok (link, lorig, title, torig)
local function link_title_ok (link, lorig, title, torig)
local orig;
local orig;
if utilities.is_set (link) then -- don't bother if <param>-link doesn't have a value
 
if is_set (link) then -- don't bother if <param>-link doesn't have a value
if not link_param_ok (link) then -- check |<param>-link= markup
if not link_param_ok (link) then -- check |<param>-link= markup
orig = lorig; -- identify the failing link parameter
orig = lorig; -- identify the failing link parameter
elseif title:find ('%[%[') then -- check |title= for wikilink markup
elseif title:find ('%[%[') then -- check |title= for wikilink markup
orig = torig; -- identify the failing |title= parameter
orig = torig; -- identify the failing |title= parameter
elseif link:match ('^%a+:') then -- if the link is what looks like an interwiki
local prefix = link:match ('^(%a+):'):lower(); -- get the interwiki prefix
if cfg.inter_wiki_map[prefix] then -- if prefix is in the map, must have preceding colon
orig = lorig; -- flag as error
end
end
end
end
end


if utilities.is_set (orig) then
if is_set (orig) then
link = ''; -- unset
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'bad_paramlink', orig)}); -- url or wikilink in |title= with |title-link=;
utilities.set_message ('err_bad_paramlink', orig); -- URL or wikilink in |title= with |title-link=;
end
end
return link; -- link if ok, empty string else
end
end


Baris 293: Baris 290:
Determines whether a URL string appears to be valid.
Determines whether a URL string appears to be valid.


First we test for space characters.  If any are found, return false.  Then split the URL into scheme and domain
First we test for space characters.  If any are found, return false.  Then split the url into scheme and domain
portions, or for protocol-relative (//example.com) URLs, just the domain.  Use is_url() to validate the two
portions, or for protocol relative (//example.com) urls, just the domain.  Use is_url() to validate the two
portions of the URL.  If both are valid, or for protocol-relative if domain is valid, return true, else false.
portions of the url.  If both are valid, or for protocol relative if domain is valid, return true, else false.


Because it is different from a standard URL, and because this module used external_link() to make external links
Because it is different from a standard url, and because this module used external_link() to make external links
that work for standard and news: links, we validate newsgroup names here.  The specification for a newsgroup name
that work for standard and news: links, we validate newsgroup names here.  The specification for a newsgroup name
is at https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5536#section-3.1.4
is at https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5536#section-3.1.4
Baris 304: Baris 301:


local function check_url( url_str )
local function check_url( url_str )
if nil == url_str:match ("^%S+$") then -- if there are any spaces in |url=value it can't be a proper URL
if nil == url_str:match ("^%S+$") then -- if there are any spaces in |url=value it can't be a proper url
return false;
return false;
end
end
local scheme, domain;
local scheme, domain;


scheme, domain = split_url (url_str); -- get scheme or nil and domain or nil from URL;
scheme, domain = split_url (url_str); -- get scheme or nil and domain or nil from url;
if 'news:' == scheme then -- special case for newsgroups
if 'news:' == scheme then -- special case for newsgroups
Baris 315: Baris 312:
end
end
return is_url (scheme, domain); -- return true if value appears to be a valid URL
return is_url (scheme, domain); -- return true if value appears to be a valid url
end
end


Baris 322: Baris 319:


Return true if a parameter value has a string that begins and ends with square brackets [ and ] and the first
Return true if a parameter value has a string that begins and ends with square brackets [ and ] and the first
non-space characters following the opening bracket appear to be a URL.  The test will also find external wikilinks
non-space characters following the opening bracket appear to be a url.  The test will also find external wikilinks
that use protocol-relative URLs. Also finds bare URLs.
that use protocol relative urls. Also finds bare urls.


The frontier pattern prevents a match on interwiki-links which are similar to scheme:path URLs.  The tests that
The frontier pattern prevents a match on interwiki links which are similar to scheme:path urls.  The tests that
find bracketed URLs are required because the parameters that call this test (currently |title=, |chapter=, |work=,
find bracketed urls are required because the parameters that call this test (currently |title=, |chapter=, |work=,
and |publisher=) may have wikilinks and there are articles or redirects like '//Hus' so, while uncommon, |title=[[//Hus]]
and |publisher=) may have wikilinks and there are articles or redirects like '//Hus' so, while uncommon, |title=[[//Hus]]
is possible as might be [[en://Hus]].
is possible as might be [[en://Hus]].
Baris 335: Baris 332:
local scheme, domain;
local scheme, domain;


if value:match ('%f[%[]%[%a%S*:%S+.*%]') then -- if ext. wikilink with scheme and domain: [xxxx://yyyyy.zzz]
if value:match ('%f[%[]%[%a%S*:%S+.*%]') then -- if ext wikilink with scheme and domain: [xxxx://yyyyy.zzz]
scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('%f[%[]%[(%a%S*:%S+).*%]'));
scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('%f[%[]%[(%a%S*:%S+).*%]'));
elseif value:match ('%f[%[]%[//%S+.*%]') then -- if protocol-relative ext. wikilink: [//yyyyy.zzz]
elseif value:match ('%f[%[]%[//%S+.*%]') then -- if protocol relative ext wikilink: [//yyyyy.zzz]
scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('%f[%[]%[(//%S+).*%]'));
scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('%f[%[]%[(//%S+).*%]'));
elseif value:match ('%a%S*:%S+') then -- if bare URL with scheme; may have leading or trailing plain text
elseif value:match ('%a%S*:%S+') then -- if bare url with scheme; may have leading or trailing plain text
scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('(%a%S*:%S+)'));
scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('(%a%S*:%S+)'));
elseif value:match ('//%S+') then -- if protocol-relative bare URL: //yyyyy.zzz; may have leading or trailing plain text
elseif value:match ('//%S+') then -- if protocol relative bare url: //yyyyy.zzz; may have leading or trailing plain text
scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('(//%S+)')); -- what is left should be the domain
scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('(//%S+)')); -- what is left should be the domain
else
else
return false; -- didn't find anything that is obviously a URL
return false; -- didn't find anything that is obviously a url
end
end


return is_url (scheme, domain); -- return true if value appears to be a valid URL
return is_url (scheme, domain); -- return true if value appears to be a valid url
end
end


Baris 357: Baris 354:
]]
]]


local function check_for_url (parameter_list, error_list)
local function check_for_url (parameter_list)
local error_message = '';
for k, v in pairs (parameter_list) do -- for each parameter in the list
for k, v in pairs (parameter_list) do -- for each parameter in the list
if is_parameter_ext_wikilink (v) then -- look at the value; if there is a URL add an error message
if is_parameter_ext_wikilink (v) then -- look at the value; if there is a url add an error message
table.insert (error_list, utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', k));
if is_set(error_message) then -- once we've added the first portion of the error message ...
error_message=error_message .. ", "; -- ... add a comma space separator
end
error_message=error_message .. "&#124;" .. k .. "="; -- add the failed parameter
end
end
end
if is_set (error_message) then -- done looping, if there is an error message, display it
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'param_has_ext_link', {error_message}, true ) } );
end
end
end
end
Baris 374: Baris 378:
local function safe_for_url( str )
local function safe_for_url( str )
if str:match( "%[%[.-%]%]" ) ~= nil then  
if str:match( "%[%[.-%]%]" ) ~= nil then  
utilities.set_message ('err_wikilink_in_url', {});
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'wikilink_in_url', {}, true ) } );
end
end
Baris 390: Baris 394:
]]
]]


local function external_link (URL, label, source, access)
local function external_link( URL, label, source, access)
local err_msg = '';
local error_str = "";
local domain;
local domain;
local path;
local path;
local base_url;
local base_url;
 
if not utilities.is_set (label) then
if not is_set( label ) then
label = URL;
label = URL;
if utilities.is_set (source) then
if is_set( source ) then
utilities.set_message ('err_bare_url_missing_title', {utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', source)});
error_str = set_error( 'bare_url_missing_title', { wrap_style ('parameter', source) }, false, " " );
else
else
error (cfg.messages["bare_url_no_origin"]); -- programmer error; valid parameter name does not have matching meta-parameter
error( cfg.messages["bare_url_no_origin"] );
end
end
end
end
if not check_url (URL) then
if not check_url( URL ) then
utilities.set_message ('err_bad_url', {utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', source)});
error_str = set_error( 'bad_url', {wrap_style ('parameter', source)}, false, " " ) .. error_str;
end
end
domain, path = URL:match ('^([/%.%-%+:%a%d]+)([/%?#].*)$'); -- split the URL into scheme plus domain and path
domain, path = URL:match ('^([/%.%-%+:%a%d]+)([/%?#].*)$'); -- split the url into scheme plus domain and path
if path then -- if there is a path portion
if path then -- if there is a path portion
path = path:gsub ('[%[%]]', {['['] = '%5b', [']'] = '%5d'}); -- replace '[' and ']' with their percent-encoded values
path = path:gsub ('[%[%]]', {['[']='%5b',[']']='%5d'}); -- replace '[' and ']' with their percent encoded values
URL = table.concat ({domain, path}); -- and reassemble
URL=domain..path; -- and reassemble
end
end
if is_set (access) then -- access level (subscription, registration, limited)
label = safe_for_url (label); -- replace square brackets and newlines


base_url = table.concat ({ "[", URL, " ", safe_for_url (label), "]" }); -- assemble a wiki-markup URL
base_url = table.concat ( -- assemble external link with access signal
 
{
if utilities.is_set (access) then -- access level (subscription, registration, limited)
'<span class="plainlinks">[', -- opening css and url markup
base_url = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['ext-link-access-signal'], {cfg.presentation[access].class, cfg.presentation[access].title, base_url}); -- add the appropriate icon
URL, -- the url
' ', -- the required space
label,
'<span style="padding-left:0.15em">', -- signal spacing css
cfg.presentation[access], -- the appropriate icon
'</span>', -- close signal spacing span
']</span>' -- close url markup and plain links span
});
else
base_url = table.concat({ "[", URL, " ", safe_for_url( label ), "]" }); -- no signal markup
end
end
 
return base_url;
return table.concat({ base_url, error_str });
end
end


Baris 430: Baris 446:
parameters in the citation.
parameters in the citation.


added_deprecated_cat is a Boolean declared in page scope variables above
added_deprecated_cat is a boolean declared in page scope variables above


]]
]]
Baris 437: Baris 453:
if not added_deprecated_cat then
if not added_deprecated_cat then
added_deprecated_cat = true; -- note that we've added this category
added_deprecated_cat = true; -- note that we've added this category
utilities.set_message ('err_deprecated_params', {name}); -- add error message
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'deprecated_params', {name}, true ) } ); -- add error message
end
end
end
end
Baris 444: Baris 460:
--[=[-------------------------< K E R N _ Q U O T E S >--------------------------------------------------------
--[=[-------------------------< K E R N _ Q U O T E S >--------------------------------------------------------


Apply kerning to open the space between the quote mark provided by the module and a leading or trailing quote
Apply kerning to open the space between the quote mark provided by the Module and a leading or trailing quote
mark contained in a |title= or |chapter= parameter's value.
mark contained in a |title= or |chapter= parameter's value.


Baris 450: Baris 466:
"'Unkerned title with leading and trailing single quote marks'"
"'Unkerned title with leading and trailing single quote marks'"
" 'Kerned title with leading and trailing single quote marks' " (in real life the kerning isn't as wide as this example)
" 'Kerned title with leading and trailing single quote marks' " (in real life the kerning isn't as wide as this example)
Double single quotes (italic or bold wiki-markup) are not kerned.
Double single quotes (italic or bold wikimarkup) are not kerned.


Replaces Unicode quote marks in plain text or in the label portion of a [[L|D]] style wikilink with typewriter
Replaces unicode quotemarks in plain text or in the label portion of a [[L|D]] style wikilink with typewriter
quote marks regardless of the need for kerning.  Unicode quote marks are not replaced in simple [[D]] wikilinks.
quote marks regardless of the need for kerning.  Unicode quote marks are not replaced in simple [[D]] wikilinks.


Call this function for chapter titles, for website titles, etc.; not for book titles.
Call this function for chapter titles, for website titles, etc; not for book titles.


]=]
]=]


local function kern_quotes (str)
local function kern_quotes (str)
local cap = '';
local cap='';
local cap2='';
local wl_type, label, link;
local wl_type, label, link;


wl_type, label, link = utilities.is_wikilink (str); -- wl_type is: 0, no wl (text in label variable); 1, [[D]]; 2, [[L|D]]
wl_type, label, link = is_wikilink (str); -- wl_type is: 0, no wl (text in label variable); 1, [[D]]; 2, [[L|D]]
if 1 == wl_type then -- [[D]] simple wikilink with or without quote marks
if 1 == wl_type then -- [[D]] simple wikilink with or without quote marks
if mw.ustring.match (str, '%[%[[\"“”\'‘’].+[\"“”\'‘’]%]%]') then -- leading and trailing quote marks
if mw.ustring.match (str, '%[%[[\"“”\'‘’].+[\"“”\'‘’]%]%]') then -- leading and trailing quote marks
str = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-left'], str);
str = substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-wl-both'], str);
str = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-right'], str);
elseif mw.ustring.match (str, '%[%[[\"“”\'‘’].+%]%]') then -- leading quote marks
elseif mw.ustring.match (str, '%[%[[\"“”\'‘’].+%]%]') then -- leading quote marks
str = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-left'], str);
str = substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-wl-left'], str);
elseif mw.ustring.match (str, '%[%[.+[\"“”\'‘’]%]%]') then -- trailing quote marks
elseif mw.ustring.match (str, '%[%[.+[\"“”\'‘’]%]%]') then -- trailing quote marks
str = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-right'], str);
str = substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-wl-right'], str);
end
end


else -- plain text or [[L|D]]; text in label variable
else -- plain text or [[L|D]]; text in label variable
label = mw.ustring.gsub (label, '[“”]', '\"'); -- replace “” (U+201C & U+201D) with " (typewriter double quote mark)
label= mw.ustring.gsub (label, '[“”]', '\"'); -- replace “” (U+201C & U+201D) with " (typewriter double quote mark)
label = mw.ustring.gsub (label, '[‘’]', '\''); -- replace ‘’ (U+2018 & U+2019) with ' (typewriter single quote mark)
label= mw.ustring.gsub (label, '[‘’]', '\''); -- replace ‘’ (U+2018 & U+2019) with ' (typewriter single quote mark)


cap = mw.ustring.match (label, "^([\"\'][^\'].+)"); -- match leading double or single quote but not doubled single quotes (italic markup)
cap, cap2 = mw.ustring.match (label, "^([\"\'])([^\'].+)"); -- match leading double or single quote but not doubled single quotes (italic markup)
if utilities.is_set (cap) then
if is_set (cap) then
label = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-left'], cap);
label = substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-left'], {cap, cap2});
end
end
cap = mw.ustring.match (label, "^(.+[^\'][\"\'])$") -- match trailing double or single quote but not doubled single quotes (italic markup)
cap, cap2 = mw.ustring.match (label, "^(.+[^\'])([\"\'])$") -- match trailing double or single quote but not doubled single quotes (italic markup)
if utilities.is_set (cap) then
if is_set (cap) then
label = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-right'], cap);
label = substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-right'], {cap, cap2});
end
end
if 2 == wl_type then
if 2 == wl_type then
str = utilities.make_wikilink (link, label); -- reassemble the wikilink
str = make_wikilink (link, label); -- reassemble the wikilink
else
else
str = label;
str = label;
Baris 501: Baris 517:
--[[--------------------------< F O R M A T _ S C R I P T _ V A L U E >----------------------------------------
--[[--------------------------< F O R M A T _ S C R I P T _ V A L U E >----------------------------------------


|script-title= holds title parameters that are not written in Latin-based scripts: Chinese, Japanese, Arabic, Hebrew, etc. These scripts should
|script-title= holds title parameters that are not written in Latin based scripts: Chinese, Japanese, Arabic, Hebrew, etc. These scripts should
not be italicized and may be written right-to-left.  The value supplied by |script-title= is concatenated onto Title after Title has been wrapped
not be italicized and may be written right-to-left.  The value supplied by |script-title= is concatenated onto Title after Title has been wrapped
in italic markup.
in italic markup.


Regardless of language, all values provided by |script-title= are wrapped in <bdi>...</bdi> tags to isolate RTL languages from the English left to right.
Regardless of language, all values provided by |script-title= are wrapped in <bdi>...</bdi> tags to isolate rtl languages from the English left to right.


|script-title= provides a unique feature.  The value in |script-title= may be prefixed with a two-character ISO 639-1 language code and a colon:
|script-title= provides a unique feature.  The value in |script-title= may be prefixed with a two-character ISO639-1 language code and a colon:
|script-title=ja:*** *** (where * represents a Japanese character)
|script-title=ja:*** *** (where * represents a Japanese character)
Spaces between the two-character code and the colon and the colon and the first script character are allowed:
Spaces between the two-character code and the colon and the colon and the first script character are allowed:
Baris 515: Baris 531:
Spaces preceding the prefix are allowed: |script-title = ja:*** ***
Spaces preceding the prefix are allowed: |script-title = ja:*** ***


The prefix is checked for validity.  If it is a valid ISO 639-1 language code, the lang attribute (lang="ja") is added to the <bdi> tag so that browsers can
The prefix is checked for validity.  If it is a valid ISO639-1 language code, the lang attribute (lang="ja") is added to the <bdi> tag so that browsers can
know the language the tag contains.  This may help the browser render the script more correctly.  If the prefix is invalid, the lang attribute
know the language the tag contains.  This may help the browser render the script more correctly.  If the prefix is invalid, the lang attribute
is not added.  At this time there is no error message for this condition.
is not added.  At this time there is no error message for this condition.


Supports |script-title=, |script-chapter=, |script-<periodical>=
Supports |script-title= and |script-chapter=


TODO: error messages when prefix is invalid ISO639-1 code; when script_value has prefix but no script;
]]
]]


local function format_script_value (script_value, script_param)
local function format_script_value (script_value)
local lang=''; -- initialize to empty string
local lang=''; -- initialize to empty string
local name;
local name;
if script_value:match('^%l%l%l?%s*:') then -- if first 3 or 4 non-space characters are script language prefix
if script_value:match('^%l%l%s*:') then -- if first 3 non-space characters are script language prefix
lang = script_value:match('^(%l%l%l?)%s*:%s*%S.*'); -- get the language prefix or nil if there is no script
lang = script_value:match('^(%l%l)%s*:%s*%S.*'); -- get the language prefix or nil if there is no script
if not utilities.is_set (lang) then
if not is_set (lang) then
utilities.set_message ('err_script_parameter', {script_param, cfg.err_msg_supl['missing title part']}); -- prefix without 'title'; add error message
return ''; -- script_value was just the prefix so return empty string
return ''; -- script_value was just the prefix so return empty string
end
end
-- if we get this far we have prefix and script
-- if we get this far we have prefix and script
name = cfg.lang_tag_remap[lang] or mw.language.fetchLanguageName( lang, cfg.this_wiki_code ); -- get language name so that we can use it to categorize
name = cfg.lang_code_remap[lang] or mw.language.fetchLanguageName( lang, "id" ); -- get language name so that we can use it to categorize
if utilities.is_set (name) then -- is prefix a proper ISO 639-1 language code?
if is_set (name) then -- is prefix a proper ISO 639-1 language code?
script_value = script_value:gsub ('^%l+%s*:%s*', ''); -- strip prefix from script
script_value = script_value:gsub ('^%l%l%s*:%s*', ''); -- strip prefix from script
-- is prefix one of these language codes?
-- is prefix one of these language codes?
if utilities.in_array (lang, cfg.script_lang_codes) then
if in_array (lang, cfg.script_lang_codes) then
utilities.add_prop_cat ('script', {name, lang})
add_prop_cat ('script_with_name', {name, lang})
else
else
utilities.set_message ('err_script_parameter', {script_param, cfg.err_msg_supl['unknown language code']}); -- unknown script-language; add error message
add_prop_cat ('script')
end
end
lang = ' lang="' .. lang .. '" '; -- convert prefix into a lang attribute
lang = ' lang="' .. lang .. '" '; -- convert prefix into a lang attribute
else
else
utilities.set_message ('err_script_parameter', {script_param, cfg.err_msg_supl['invalid language code']}); -- invalid language code; add error message
lang = ''; -- invalid so set lang to empty string
lang = ''; -- invalid so set lang to empty string
end
end
else
utilities.set_message ('err_script_parameter', {script_param, cfg.err_msg_supl['missing prefix']}); -- no language code prefix; add error message
end
end
script_value = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['bdi'], {lang, script_value}); -- isolate in case script is RTL
script_value = substitute (cfg.presentation['bdi'], {lang, script_value}); -- isolate in case script is rtl


return script_value;
return script_value;
Baris 558: Baris 571:
--[[--------------------------< S C R I P T _ C O N C A T E N A T E >------------------------------------------
--[[--------------------------< S C R I P T _ C O N C A T E N A T E >------------------------------------------


Initially for |title= and |script-title=, this function concatenates those two parameter values after the script
Initially for |title= and |script-title=, this function concatenates those two parameter values after the script value has been  
value has been wrapped in <bdi> tags.
wrapped in <bdi> tags.
 
]]
]]


local function script_concatenate (title, script, script_param)
local function script_concatenate (title, script)
if utilities.is_set (script) then
if is_set (script) then
script = format_script_value (script, script_param); -- <bdi> tags, lang attribute, categorization, etc.; returns empty string on error
script = format_script_value (script); -- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; returns empty string on error
if utilities.is_set (script) then
if is_set (script) then
title = title .. ' ' .. script; -- concatenate title and script title
title = title .. ' ' .. script; -- concatenate title and script title
end
end
Baris 583: Baris 595:


local function wrap_msg (key, str, lower)
local function wrap_msg (key, str, lower)
if not utilities.is_set ( str ) then
if not is_set( str ) then
return "";
return "";
end
end
Baris 589: Baris 601:
local msg;
local msg;
msg = cfg.messages[key]:lower(); -- set the message to lower case before  
msg = cfg.messages[key]:lower(); -- set the message to lower case before  
return utilities.substitute ( msg, str ); -- including template text
return substitute( msg, str ); -- including template text
else
else
return utilities.substitute ( cfg.messages[key], str );
return substitute( cfg.messages[key], str );
end
end
end
end




--[[----------------< W I K I S O U R C E _ U R L _ M A K E >-------------------
--[[--------------------------< F O R M A T _ C H A P T E R _ T I T L E >--------------------------------------
 
Makes a Wikisource URL from Wikisource interwiki-link.  Returns the URL and appropriate
label; nil else.


str is the value assigned to |chapter= (or aliases) or |title= or |title-link=
Format the four chapter parameters: |script-chapter=, |chapter=, |trans-chapter=, and |chapter-url= into a single Chapter meta-
parameter (chapter_url_source used for error messages).


]]
]]


local function wikisource_url_make (str)
local function format_chapter_title (scriptchapter, chapter, transchapter, chapterurl, chapter_url_source, no_quotes, access)
local wl_type, D, L;
local chapter_error = '';
local ws_url, ws_label;
local wikisource_prefix = table.concat ({'https://', cfg.this_wiki_code, '.wikisource.org/wiki/'});
if not is_set (chapter) then
 
chapter = ''; -- to be safe for concatenation
wl_type, D, L = utilities.is_wikilink (str); -- wl_type is 0 (not a wikilink), 1 (simple wikilink), 2 (complex wikilink)
else
 
if false == no_quotes then
if 0 == wl_type then -- not a wikilink; might be from |title-link=
chapter = kern_quotes (chapter); -- if necessary, separate chapter title's leading and trailing quote marks from Module provided quote marks
str = D:match ('^[Ww]ikisource:(.+)') or D:match ('^[Ss]:(.+)'); -- article title from interwiki link with long-form or short-form namespace
chapter = wrap_style ('quoted-title', chapter);
if utilities.is_set (str) then
ws_url = table.concat ({ -- build a Wikisource URL
wikisource_prefix, -- prefix
str, -- article title
});
ws_label = str; -- label for the URL
end
elseif 1 == wl_type then -- simple wikilink: [[Wikisource:ws article]]
str = D:match ('^[Ww]ikisource:(.+)') or D:match ('^[Ss]:(.+)'); -- article title from interwiki link with long-form or short-form namespace
if utilities.is_set (str) then
ws_url = table.concat ({ -- build a Wikisource URL
wikisource_prefix, -- prefix
str, -- article title
});
ws_label = str; -- label for the URL
end
elseif 2 == wl_type then -- non-so-simple wikilink: [[Wikisource:ws article|displayed text]] ([[L|D]])
str = L:match ('^[Ww]ikisource:(.+)') or L:match ('^[Ss]:(.+)'); -- article title from interwiki link with long-form or short-form namespace
if utilities.is_set (str) then
ws_label = D; -- get ws article name from display portion of interwiki link
ws_url = table.concat ({ -- build a Wikisource URL
wikisource_prefix, -- prefix
str, -- article title without namespace from link portion of wikilink
});
end
end
end
end


if ws_url then
chapter = script_concatenate (chapter, scriptchapter) -- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; must be done after title is wrapped
ws_url = mw.uri.encode (ws_url, 'WIKI'); -- make a usable URL
 
ws_url = ws_url:gsub ('%%23', '#'); -- undo percent-encoding of fragment marker
if is_set (chapterurl) then
chapter = external_link (chapterurl, chapter, chapter_url_source, access); -- adds bare_url_missing_title error if appropriate
end
end


return ws_url, ws_label, L or D; -- return proper URL or nil and a label or nil
if is_set (transchapter) then
end
transchapter = wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', transchapter);
if is_set (chapter) then
chapter = chapter ..  ' ' .. transchapter;
else -- here when transchapter without chapter or script-chapter
chapter = transchapter; --  
chapter_error = ' ' .. set_error ('trans_missing_title', {'chapter'});
end
end


-- if is_set (chapterurl) then
-- chapter = external_link (chapterurl, chapter, chapter_url_source, access); -- adds bare_url_missing_title error if appropriate
-- end


--[[----------------< F O R M A T _ P E R I O D I C A L >-----------------------
return chapter .. chapter_error;
 
end
Format the three periodical parameters: |script-<periodical>=, |<periodical>=,
and |trans-<periodical>= into a single Periodical meta-parameter.
 
]]
 
local function format_periodical (script_periodical, script_periodical_source, periodical, trans_periodical)


if not utilities.is_set (periodical) then
periodical = ''; -- to be safe for concatenation
else
periodical = utilities.wrap_style ('italic-title', periodical); -- style
end


periodical = script_concatenate (periodical, script_periodical, script_periodical_source); -- <bdi> tags, lang attribute, categorization, etc.; must be done after title is wrapped
--[[--------------------------< H A S _ I N V I S I B L E _ C H A R S >----------------------------------------


if utilities.is_set (trans_periodical) then
This function searches a parameter's value for nonprintable or invisible characters. The search stops at the
trans_periodical = utilities.wrap_style ('trans-italic-title', trans_periodical);
first match.
if utilities.is_set (periodical) then
periodical = periodical .. ' ' .. trans_periodical;
else -- here when trans-periodical without periodical or script-periodical
periodical = trans_periodical;
utilities.set_message ('err_trans_missing_title', {'periodical'});
end
end


return periodical;
This function will detect the visible replacement character when it is part of the wikisource.
end


Detects but ignores nowiki and math stripmarkers.  Also detects other named stripmarkers (gallery, math, pre, ref)
and identifies them with a slightly different error message.  See also coins_cleanup().


--[[------------------< F O R M A T _ C H A P T E R _ T I T L E >---------------
Detects but ignores the character pattern that results from the transclusion of {{'}} templates.


Format the four chapter parameters: |script-chapter=, |chapter=, |trans-chapter=,
Output of this function is an error message that identifies the character or the Unicode group, or the stripmarker
and |chapter-url= into a single chapter meta- parameter (chapter_url_source used
that was detected along with its position (or, for multi-byte characters, the position of its first byte) in the
for error messages).
parameter value.


]]
]]


local function format_chapter_title (script_chapter, script_chapter_source, chapter, chapter_source, trans_chapter, trans_chapter_source, chapter_url, chapter_url_source, no_quotes, access)
local function has_invisible_chars (param, v)
local ws_url, ws_label, L = wikisource_url_make (chapter); -- make a wikisource URL and label from a wikisource interwiki link
local position = ''; -- position of invisible char or starting position of stripmarker
if ws_url then
local dummy; -- end of matching string; not used but required to hold end position when a capture is returned
ws_label = ws_label:gsub ('_', ' '); -- replace underscore separators with space characters
local capture; -- used by stripmarker detection to hold name of the stripmarker
chapter = ws_label;
local i=1;
local stripmarker, apostrophe;
capture = string.match (v, '[%w%p ]*'); -- Test for values that are simple ASCII text and bypass other tests if true
if capture == v then -- if same there are no unicode characters
return;
end
end


if not utilities.is_set (chapter) then
while cfg.invisible_chars[i] do
chapter = ''; -- to be safe for concatenation
local char=cfg.invisible_chars[i][1] -- the character or group name
else
local pattern=cfg.invisible_chars[i][2] -- the pattern used to find it
if false == no_quotes then
position, dummy, capture = mw.ustring.find (v, pattern) -- see if the parameter value contains characters that match the pattern
chapter = kern_quotes (chapter); -- if necessary, separate chapter title's leading and trailing quote marks from module provided quote marks
chapter = utilities.wrap_style ('quoted-title', chapter);
if position and (char == 'zero width joiner') then -- if we found a zero width joiner character
end
if mw.ustring.find (v, cfg.indic_script) then -- its ok if one of the indic scripts
end
position = nil; -- unset position
 
end
chapter = script_concatenate (chapter, script_chapter, script_chapter_source); -- <bdi> tags, lang attribute, categorization, etc.; must be done after title is wrapped
 
if utilities.is_set (chapter_url) then
chapter = external_link (chapter_url, chapter, chapter_url_source, access); -- adds bare_url_missing_title error if appropriate
elseif ws_url then
chapter = external_link (ws_url, chapter .. '&nbsp;', 'ws link in chapter'); -- adds bare_url_missing_title error if appropriate; space char to move icon away from chap text; TODO: better way to do this?
chapter = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['interwiki-icon'], {cfg.presentation['class-wikisource'], L, chapter});
end
 
if utilities.is_set (trans_chapter) then
trans_chapter = utilities.wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', trans_chapter);
if utilities.is_set (chapter) then
chapter = chapter .. ' ' .. trans_chapter;
else -- here when trans_chapter without chapter or script-chapter
chapter = trans_chapter;
chapter_source = trans_chapter_source:match ('trans%-?(.+)'); -- when no chapter, get matching name from trans-<param>
utilities.set_message ('err_trans_missing_title', {chapter_source});
end
end
 
return chapter;
end
 
 
--[[----------------< H A S _ I N V I S I B L E _ C H A R S >-------------------
 
This function searches a parameter's value for non-printable or invisible characters.
The search stops at the first match.
 
This function will detect the visible replacement character when it is part of the Wikisource.
 
Detects but ignores nowiki and math stripmarkers.  Also detects other named stripmarkers
(gallery, math, pre, ref) and identifies them with a slightly different error message.
See also coins_cleanup().
 
Output of this function is an error message that identifies the character or the
Unicode group, or the stripmarker that was detected along with its position (or,
for multi-byte characters, the position of its first byte) in the parameter value.
 
]]
 
local function has_invisible_chars (param, v)
local position = ''; -- position of invisible char or starting position of stripmarker
local capture; -- used by stripmarker detection to hold name of the stripmarker
local stripmarker; -- boolean set true when a stripmarker is found
 
capture = string.match (v, '[%w%p ]*'); -- test for values that are simple ASCII text and bypass other tests if true
if capture == v then -- if same there are no Unicode characters
return;
end
 
for _, invisible_char in ipairs (cfg.invisible_chars) do
local char_name = invisible_char[1]; -- the character or group name
local pattern = invisible_char[2]; -- the pattern used to find it
position, _, capture = mw.ustring.find (v, pattern); -- see if the parameter value contains characters that match the pattern
if position and (cfg.invisible_defs.zwj == capture) then -- if we found a zero-width joiner character
if mw.ustring.find (v, cfg.indic_script) then -- it's ok if one of the Indic scripts
position = nil; -- unset position
elseif cfg.emoji_t[mw.ustring.codepoint (v, position+1)] then -- is zwj followed by a character listed in emoji{}?
position = nil; -- unset position
end
end
end
if position then
if position then
if 'nowiki' == capture or 'math' == capture or -- nowiki and math stripmarkers (not an error condition)
if 'nowiki' == capture or 'math' == capture then -- nowiki, math stripmarker (not an error condition)
('templatestyles' == capture and utilities.in_array (param, {'id', 'quote'})) then -- templatestyles stripmarker allowed in these parameters
stripmarker = true; -- set a flag
stripmarker = true; -- set a flag
elseif true == stripmarker and 'delete' == char then -- because stripmakers begin and end with the delete char, assume that we've found one end of a stripmarker
elseif true == stripmarker and cfg.invisible_defs.del == capture then -- because stripmakers begin and end with the delete char, assume that we've found one end of a stripmarker
position = nil; -- unset
position = nil; -- unset
else
else
local err_msg;
local err_msg;
if capture and not (cfg.invisible_defs.del == capture or cfg.invisible_defs.zwj == capture) then
if capture then
err_msg = capture .. ' ' .. char_name;
err_msg = capture .. ' ' .. char;
else
else
err_msg = char_name .. ' ' .. 'character';
err_msg = char .. ' ' .. 'character';
end
end


utilities.set_message ('err_invisible_char', {err_msg, utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', param), position}); -- add error message
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'invisible_char', {err_msg, wrap_style ('parameter', param), position}, true ) } ); -- add error message
return; -- and done with this parameter
return; -- and done with this parameter
end
end
end
end
i=i+1; -- bump our index
end
end
end
end




--[[-------------------< A R G U M E N T _ W R A P P E R >----------------------
--[[--------------------------< A R G U M E N T _ W R A P P E R >----------------------------------------------


Argument wrapper.  This function provides support for argument mapping defined
Argument wrapper.  This function provides support for argument mapping defined in the configuration file so that
in the configuration file so that multiple names can be transparently aliased to
multiple names can be transparently aliased to single internal variable.
single internal variable.


]]
]]


local function argument_wrapper ( args )
local function argument_wrapper( args )
local origin = {};
local origin = {};
return setmetatable({
return setmetatable({
ORIGIN = function ( self, k )
ORIGIN = function( self, k )
local dummy = self[k]; -- force the variable to be loaded.
local dummy = self[k]; --force the variable to be loaded.
return origin[k];
return origin[k];
end
end
Baris 817: Baris 739:
if type( list ) == 'table' then
if type( list ) == 'table' then
v, origin[k] = utilities.select_one ( args, list, 'err_redundant_parameters' );
v, origin[k] = select_one( args, list, 'redundant_parameters' );
if origin[k] == nil then
if origin[k] == nil then
origin[k] = ''; -- Empty string, not nil
origin[k] = ''; -- Empty string, not nil
end
end
elseif list ~= nil then
elseif list ~= nil then
Baris 826: Baris 748:
-- maybe let through instead of raising an error?
-- maybe let through instead of raising an error?
-- v, origin[k] = args[k], k;
-- v, origin[k] = args[k], k;
error( cfg.messages['unknown_argument_map'] .. ': ' .. k);
error( cfg.messages['unknown_argument_map'] );
end
end
-- Empty strings, not nil;
-- Empty strings, not nil;
if v == nil then
if v == nil then
v = '';
v = cfg.defaults[k] or '';
origin[k] = '';
origin[k] = '';
end
end
Baris 842: Baris 764:




--[[--------------------------< N O W R A P _ D A T E >-------------------------
--[[--------------------------< V A L I D A T E >--------------------------------------------------------------


When date is YYYY-MM-DD format wrap in nowrap span: <span ...>YYYY-MM-DD</span>.
Looks for a parameter's name in one of several whitelists.
When date is DD MMMM YYYY or is MMMM DD, YYYY then wrap in nowrap span:
<span ...>DD MMMM</span> YYYY or <span ...>MMMM DD,</span> YYYY
 
DOES NOT yet support MMMM YYYY or any of the date ranges.


Parameters in the whitelist can have three values:
true - active, supported parameters
false - deprecated, supported parameters
nil - unsupported parameters
]]
]]


local function nowrap_date (date)
local function validate( name, cite_class )
local cap = '';
local name = tostring( name );
local cap2 = '';
local state;
 
if date:match("^%d%d%d%d%-%d%d%-%d%d$") then
date = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['nowrap1'], date);
elseif date:match("^%a+%s*%d%d?,%s+%d%d%d%d$") or date:match ("^%d%d?%s*%a+%s+%d%d%d%d$") then
if in_array (cite_class, {'arxiv', 'biorxiv', 'citeseerx'}) then -- limited parameter sets allowed for these templates
cap, cap2 = string.match (date, "^(.*)%s+(%d%d%d%d)$");
state = whitelist.limited_basic_arguments[ name ];
date = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['nowrap2'], {cap, cap2});
if true == state then return true; end -- valid actively supported parameter
end
if false == state then
deprecated_parameter (name); -- parameter is deprecated but still supported
return date;
return true;
end
end


 
if 'arxiv' == cite_class then -- basic parameters unique to these templates
--[[--------------------------< S E T _ T I T L E T Y P E >---------------------
state = whitelist.arxiv_basic_arguments[name];
 
end
This function sets default title types (equivalent to the citation including
if 'biorxiv' == cite_class then
|type=<default value>) for those templates that have defaults. Also handles the
state = whitelist.biorxiv_basic_arguments[name];
special case where it is desirable to omit the title type from the rendered citation
end
(|type=none).
if 'citeseerx' == cite_class then
 
state = whitelist.citeseerx_basic_arguments[name];
]]
 
local function set_titletype (cite_class, title_type)
if utilities.is_set (title_type) then
if 'none' == cfg.keywords_xlate[title_type] then
title_type = ''; -- if |type=none then type parameter not displayed
end
end
return title_type; -- if |type= has been set to any other value use that value
end


return cfg.title_types [cite_class] or ''; -- set template's default title type; else empty string for concatenation
if true == state then return true; end -- valid actively supported parameter
if false == state then
deprecated_parameter (name); -- parameter is deprecated but still supported
return true;
end
-- limited enumerated parameters list
name = name:gsub("%d+", "#" ); -- replace digit(s) with # (last25 becomes last#) (mw.ustring because non-Western 'local' digits)
state = whitelist.limited_numbered_arguments[ name ];
if true == state then return true; end -- valid actively supported parameter
if false == state then
deprecated_parameter (name); -- parameter is deprecated but still supported
return true;
end
 
return false; -- not supported because not found or name is set to nil
end -- end limited parameter-set templates
state = whitelist.basic_arguments[ name ]; -- all other templates; all normal parameters allowed
if true == state then return true; end -- valid actively supported parameter
if false == state then
deprecated_parameter (name); -- parameter is deprecated but still supported
return true;
end
-- all enumerated parameters allowed
name = name:gsub("%d+", "#" ); -- replace digit(s) with # (last25 becomes last#) (mw.ustring because non-Western 'local' digits)
state = whitelist.numbered_arguments[ name ];
 
if true == state then return true; end -- valid actively supported parameter
if false == state then
deprecated_parameter (name); -- parameter is deprecated but still supported
return true;
end
return false; -- not supported because not found or name is set to nil
end
end




--[[--------------------------< S A F E _ J O I N >-----------------------------
--[[--------------------------< N O W R A P _ D A T E >--------------------------------------------------------
 
When date is YYYY-MM-DD format wrap in nowrap span: <span ...>YYYY-MM-DD</span>.  When date is DD MMMM YYYY or is
MMMM DD, YYYY then wrap in nowrap span: <span ...>DD MMMM</span> YYYY or <span ...>MMMM DD,</span> YYYY


Joins a sequence of strings together while checking for duplicate separation characters.
DOES NOT yet support MMMM YYYY or any of the date ranges.


]]
]]


local function safe_join( tbl, duplicate_char )
local function nowrap_date (date)
local f = {}; -- create a function table appropriate to type of 'duplicate character'
local cap='';
if 1 == #duplicate_char then -- for single byte ASCII characters use the string library functions
local cap2='';
f.gsub = string.gsub
f.match = string.match
f.sub = string.sub
else -- for multi-byte characters use the ustring library functions
f.gsub = mw.ustring.gsub
f.match = mw.ustring.match
f.sub = mw.ustring.sub
end


local str = ''; -- the output string
if date:match("^%d%d%d%d%-%d%d%-%d%d$") then
local comp = ''; -- what does 'comp' mean?
date = substitute (cfg.presentation['nowrap1'], date);
local end_chr = '';
local trim;
elseif date:match("^%a+%s*%d%d?,%s+%d%d%d%d$") or date:match ("^%d%d?%s*%a+%s+%d%d%d%d$") then
for _, value in ipairs( tbl ) do
cap, cap2 = string.match (date, "^(.*)%s+(%d%d%d%d)$");
if value == nil then value = ''; end
date = substitute (cfg.presentation['nowrap2'], {cap, cap2});
end
if str == '' then -- if output string is empty
str = value; -- assign value to it (first time through the loop)
return date;
elseif value ~= '' then
end
if value:sub(1, 1) == '<' then -- special case of values enclosed in spans and other markup.
 
comp = value:gsub( "%b<>", "" ); -- remove HTML markup (<span>string</span> -> string)
 
else
--[[--------------------------< S E T _ T I T L E T Y P E >----------------------------------------------------
comp = value;
 
end
This function sets default title types (equivalent to the citation including |type=<default value>) for those templates that have defaults.
-- typically duplicate_char is sepc
Also handles the special case where it is desirable to omit the title type from the rendered citation (|type=none).
if f.sub(comp, 1, 1) == duplicate_char then -- is first character same as duplicate_char? why test first character?
 
--   Because individual string segments often (always?) begin with terminal punct for the
]]
--   preceding segment: 'First element' .. 'sepc next element' .. etc.?
 
trim = false;
local function set_titletype (cite_class, title_type)
end_chr = f.sub(str, -1, -1); -- get the last character of the output string
if is_set(title_type) then
-- str = str .. "<HERE(enchr=" .. end_chr .. ")" -- debug stuff?
if "none" == title_type then
if end_chr == duplicate_char then -- if same as separator
title_type = ""; -- if |type=none then type parameter not displayed
str = f.sub(str, 1, -2); -- remove it
end
elseif end_chr == "'" then -- if it might be wiki-markup
return title_type; -- if |type= has been set to any other value use that value
if f.sub(str, -3, -1) == duplicate_char .. "''" then -- if last three chars of str are sepc''
end
str = f.sub(str, 1, -4) .. "''"; -- remove them and add back ''
elseif  f.sub(str, -5, -1) == duplicate_char .. "]]''" then -- if last five chars of str are sepc]]''
trim = true; -- why? why do this and next differently from previous?
elseif f.sub(str, -4, -1) == duplicate_char .. "]''" then -- if last four chars of str are sepc]''
trim = true; -- same question
end
elseif end_chr == "]" then -- if it might be wiki-markup
if f.sub(str, -3, -1) == duplicate_char .. "]]" then -- if last three chars of str are sepc]] wikilink
trim = true;
elseif f.sub(str, -3, -1) == duplicate_char .. '"]' then -- if last three chars of str are sepc"] quoted external link
trim = true;
elseif  f.sub(str, -2, -1) == duplicate_char .. "]" then -- if last two chars of str are sepc] external link
trim = true;
elseif f.sub(str, -4, -1) == duplicate_char .. "'']" then -- normal case when |url=something & |title=Title.
trim = true;
end
elseif end_chr == " " then -- if last char of output string is a space
if f.sub(str, -2, -1) == duplicate_char .. " " then -- if last two chars of str are <sepc><space>
str = f.sub(str, 1, -3); -- remove them both
end
end


if trim then
return cfg.title_types [cite_class] or ''; -- set template's default title type; else empty string for concatenation
if value ~= comp then -- value does not equal comp when value contains HTML markup
local dup2 = duplicate_char;
if f.match(dup2, "%A" ) then dup2 = "%" .. dup2; end -- if duplicate_char not a letter then escape it
value = f.gsub(value, "(%b<>)" .. dup2, "%1", 1 ) -- remove duplicate_char if it follows HTML markup
else
value = f.sub(value, 2, -1 ); -- remove duplicate_char when it is first character
end
end
end
str = str .. value; -- add it to the output string
end
end
return str;
end
end




--[[--------------------------< I S _ S U F F I X >-----------------------------
--[[--------------------------< H Y P H E N _ T O _ D A S H >--------------------------------------------------


returns true if suffix is properly formed Jr, Sr, or ordinal in the range 1–9.
Converts a hyphen to a dash
Puncutation not allowed.


]]
]]


local function is_suffix (suffix)
local function hyphen_to_dash( str )
if utilities.in_array (suffix, {'Jr', 'Sr', 'Jnr', 'Snr', '1st', '2nd', '3rd'}) or suffix:match ('^%dth$') then
if not is_set(str) or str:match( "[%[%]{}<>]" ) ~= nil then
return true;
return str;
end
end
return false;
return str:gsub( '-', '–' );
end
end




--[[--------------------< I S _ G O O D _ V A N C _ N A M E >-------------------
--[[--------------------------< S A F E _ J O I N >------------------------------------------------------------


For Vancouver style, author/editor names are supposed to be rendered in Latin
Joins a sequence of strings together while checking for duplicate separation characters.
(read ASCII) characters.  When a name uses characters that contain diacritical
marks, those characters are to be converted to the corresponding Latin
character. When a name is written using a non-Latin alphabet or logogram, that
name is to be transliterated into Latin characters. The module doesn't do this
so editors may/must.


This test allows |first= and |last= names to contain any of the letters defined
]]
in the four Unicode Latin character sets
[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0000.pdf C0 Controls and Basic Latin] 0041–005A, 0061–007A
[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0080.pdf C1 Controls and Latin-1 Supplement] 00C0–00D6, 00D8–00F6, 00F8–00FF
[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0100.pdf Latin Extended-A] 0100–017F
[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0180.pdf Latin Extended-B] 0180–01BF, 01C4–024F


|lastn= also allowed to contain hyphens, spaces, and apostrophes.
local function safe_join( tbl, duplicate_char )
(http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35029/)
local f = {}; -- create a function table appropriate to type of 'dupicate character'
|firstn= also allowed to contain hyphens, spaces, apostrophes, and periods
if 1 == #duplicate_char then -- for single byte ascii characters use the string library functions
 
f.gsub=string.gsub
This original test:
f.match=string.match
if nil == mw.ustring.find (last, "^[A-Za-zÀ-ÖØ-öø-ƿDŽ-ɏ%-%s%']*$")
f.sub=string.sub
or nil == mw.ustring.find (first, "^[A-Za-zÀ-ÖØ-öø-ƿDŽ-ɏ%-%s%'%.]+[2-6%a]*$") then
else -- for multi-byte characters use the ustring library functions
was written outside of the code editor and pasted here because the code editor
f.gsub=mw.ustring.gsub
gets confused between character insertion point and cursor position. The test has
f.match=mw.ustring.match
been rewritten to use decimal character escape sequence for the individual bytes
f.sub=mw.ustring.sub
of the Unicode characters so that it is not necessary to use an external editor
to maintain this code.
 
\195\128-\195\150 – À-Ö (U+00C0–U+00D6 – C0 controls)
\195\152-\195\182 – Ø-ö (U+00D8-U+00F6 – C0 controls)
\195\184-\198\191 – ø-ƿ (U+00F8-U+01BF – C0 controls, Latin extended A & B)
\199\132-\201\143 – DŽ-ɏ (U+01C4-U+024F – Latin extended B)
 
]]
 
local function is_good_vanc_name (last, first, suffix, position)
if not suffix then
if first:find ('[,%s]') then -- when there is a space or comma, might be first name/initials + generational suffix
first = first:match ('(.-)[,%s]+'); -- get name/initials
suffix = first:match ('[,%s]+(.+)$'); -- get generational suffix
end
end
if utilities.is_set (suffix) then
if not is_suffix (suffix) then
add_vanc_error (cfg.err_msg_supl.suffix, position);
return false; -- not a name with an appropriate suffix
end
end
end
if nil == mw.ustring.find (last, "^[A-Za-z\195\128-\195\150\195\152-\195\182\195\184-\198\191\199\132-\201\143%-%s%']*$") or
nil == mw.ustring.find (first, "^[A-Za-z\195\128-\195\150\195\152-\195\182\195\184-\198\191\199\132-\201\143%-%s%'%.]*$") then
add_vanc_error (cfg.err_msg_supl['non-Latin char'], position);
return false; -- not a string of Latin characters; Vancouver requires Romanization
end;
return true;
end


 
local str = ''; -- the output string
--[[--------------------------< R E D U C E _ T O _ I N I T I A L S >------------------------------------------
local comp = ''; -- what does 'comp' mean?
 
local end_chr = '';
Attempts to convert names to initials in support of |name-list-style=vanc. 
local trim;
 
for _, value in ipairs( tbl ) do
Names in |firstn= may be separated by spaces or hyphens, or for initials, a period.
if value == nil then value = ''; end
See http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35062/.
 
if str == '' then -- if output string is empty
Vancouver style requires family rank designations (Jr, II, III, etc.) to be rendered
str = value; -- assign value to it (first time through the loop)
as Jr, 2nd, 3rd, etc.  See http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35085/.
elseif value ~= '' then
This code only accepts and understands generational suffix in the Vancouver format
if value:sub(1,1) == '<' then -- Special case of values enclosed in spans and other markup.
because Roman numerals look like, and can be mistaken for, initials.
comp = value:gsub( "%b<>", "" ); -- remove html markup (<span>string</span> -> string)
 
This function uses ustring functions because firstname initials may be any of the
Unicode Latin characters accepted by is_good_vanc_name ().
 
]]
 
local function reduce_to_initials(first, position)
local name, suffix = mw.ustring.match(first, "^(%u+) ([%dJS][%drndth]+)$");
 
if not name then -- if not initials and a suffix
name = mw.ustring.match(first, "^(%u+)$"); -- is it just initials?
end
 
if name then -- if first is initials with or without suffix
if 3 > mw.ustring.len (name) then -- if one or two initials
if suffix then -- if there is a suffix
if is_suffix (suffix) then -- is it legitimate?
return first; -- one or two initials and a valid suffix so nothing to do
else
add_vanc_error (cfg.err_msg_supl.suffix, position); -- one or two initials with invalid suffix so error message
return first; -- and return first unmolested
end
else
else
return first; -- one or two initials without suffix; nothing to do
comp = value;
end
end
end
-- typically duplicate_char is sepc
end -- if here then name has 3 or more uppercase letters so treat them as a word
if f.sub(comp, 1,1) == duplicate_char then -- is first character same as duplicate_char? why test first character?
--  Because individual string segments often (always?) begin with terminal punct for the
--  preceding segment: 'First element' .. 'sepc next element' .. etc?
trim = false;
end_chr = f.sub(str, -1,-1); -- get the last character of the output string
-- str = str .. "<HERE(enchr=" .. end_chr.. ")" -- debug stuff?
if end_chr == duplicate_char then -- if same as separator
str = f.sub(str, 1,-2); -- remove it
elseif end_chr == "'" then -- if it might be wikimarkup
if f.sub(str, -3,-1) == duplicate_char .. "''" then -- if last three chars of str are sepc''
str = f.sub(str, 1, -4) .. "''"; -- remove them and add back ''
elseif  f.sub(str, -5,-1) == duplicate_char .. "]]''" then -- if last five chars of str are sepc]]''
trim = true; -- why? why do this and next differently from previous?
elseif f.sub(str, -4,-1) == duplicate_char .. "]''" then -- if last four chars of str are sepc]''
trim = true; -- same question
end
elseif end_chr == "]" then -- if it might be wikimarkup
if f.sub(str, -3,-1) == duplicate_char .. "]]" then -- if last three chars of str are sepc]] wikilink
trim = true;
elseif f.sub(str, -3,-1) == duplicate_char .. '"]' then -- if last three chars of str are sepc"] quoted external link
trim = true;
elseif  f.sub(str, -2,-1) == duplicate_char .. "]" then -- if last two chars of str are sepc] external link
trim = true;
elseif f.sub(str, -4,-1) == duplicate_char .. "'']" then -- normal case when |url=something & |title=Title.
trim = true;
end
elseif end_chr == " " then -- if last char of output string is a space
if f.sub(str, -2,-1) == duplicate_char .. " " then -- if last two chars of str are <sepc><space>
str = f.sub(str, 1,-3); -- remove them both
end
end
 
if trim then
if value ~= comp then -- value does not equal comp when value contains html markup
local dup2 = duplicate_char;
if f.match(dup2, "%A" ) then dup2 = "%" .. dup2; end -- if duplicate_char not a letter then escape it
value = f.gsub(value, "(%b<>)" .. dup2, "%1", 1 ) -- remove duplicate_char if it follows html markup
else
value = f.sub(value, 2, -1 ); -- remove duplicate_char when it is first character
end
end
end
str = str .. value; --add it to the output string
end
end
return str;
end


local initials, names = {}, {}; -- tables to hold name parts and initials
local i = 1; -- counter for number of initials


names = mw.text.split (first, '[%s,]+'); -- split into a table of names and possible suffix
--[[--------------------------< I S _ S U F F I X >------------------------------------------------------------


while names[i] do -- loop through the table
returns true is suffix is properly formed Jr, Sr, or ordinal in the range 2–9.  Puncutation not allowed.
if 1 < i and names[i]:match ('[%dJS][%drndth]+%.?$') then -- if not the first name, and looks like a suffix (may have trailing dot)
 
names[i] = names[i]:gsub ('%.', ''); -- remove terminal dot if present
]]
if is_suffix (names[i]) then -- if a legitimate suffix
 
table.insert (initials, ' ' .. names[i]); -- add a separator space, insert at end of initials table
local function is_suffix (suffix)
break; -- and done because suffix must fall at the end of a name
if in_array (suffix, {'Jr', 'Sr', '2nd', '3rd'}) or suffix:match ('^%dth$') then
end -- no error message if not a suffix; possibly because of Romanization
return true;
end
if 3 > i then
table.insert (initials, mw.ustring.sub(names[i], 1, 1)); -- insert the initial at end of initials table
end
i = i + 1; -- bump the counter
end
end
return false;
return table.concat(initials) -- Vancouver format does not include spaces.
end
end




--[[--------------------------< I N T E R W I K I _ P R E F I X E N _ G E T >----------------------------------
--[[--------------------------< I S _ G O O D _ V A N C _ N A M E >--------------------------------------------
 
For Vancouver Style, author/editor names are supposed to be rendered in Latin (read ASCII) characters.  When a name
uses characters that contain diacritical marks, those characters are to converted to the corresponding Latin character.
When a name is written using a non-Latin alphabet or logogram, that name is to be transliterated into Latin characters.
These things are not currently possible in this module so are left to the editor to do.
 
This test allows |first= and |last= names to contain any of the letters defined in the four Unicode Latin character sets
[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0000.pdf C0 Controls and Basic Latin] 0041–005A, 0061–007A
[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0080.pdf C1 Controls and Latin-1 Supplement] 00C0–00D6, 00D8–00F6, 00F8–00FF
[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0100.pdf Latin Extended-A] 0100–017F
[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0180.pdf Latin Extended-B] 0180–01BF, 01C4–024F
 
|lastn= also allowed to contain hyphens, spaces, and apostrophes. (http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35029/)
|firstn= also allowed to contain hyphens, spaces, apostrophes, and periods


extract interwiki prefixen from <value>.  Returns two one or two values:
This original test:
false – no prefixen
if nil == mw.ustring.find (last, "^[A-Za-zÀ-ÖØ-öø-ƿDŽ-ɏ%-%s%']*$") or nil == mw.ustring.find (first, "^[A-Za-zÀ-ÖØ-öø-ƿDŽ-ɏ%-%s%'%.]+[2-6%a]*$") then
nil – prefix exists but not recognized
was written ouside of the code editor and pasted here because the code editor gets confused between character insertion point and cursor position.
project prefix, language prefix – when value has either of:
The test has been rewritten to use decimal character escape sequence for the individual bytes of the unicode characters so that it is not necessary
:<project>:<language>:<article>
to use an external editor to maintain this code.
:<language>:<project>:<article>
project prefix, nil – when <value> has only a known single-letter prefix
nil, language prefix – when <value> has only a known language prefix


accepts single-letter project prefixen: 'd' (wikidata), 's' (wikisource), and 'w' (wikipedia) prefixes; at this
\195\128-\195\150 – À-Ö (U+00C0–U+00D6 – C0 controls)
writing, the other single-letter prefixen (b (wikibook), c (commons), m (meta), n (wikinews), q (wikiquote), and
\195\152-\195\182 – Ø-ö (U+00D8-U+00F6 – C0 controls)
v (wikiversity)) are not supported.
\195\184-\198\191 – ø-ƿ (U+00F8-U+01BF – C0 controls, Latin extended A & B)
\199\132-\201\143 – DŽ-ɏ (U+01C4-U+024F – Latin extended B)


]]
]]


local function interwiki_prefixen_get (value, is_link)
local function is_good_vanc_name (last, first)
if not value:find (':%l+:') then -- if no prefix
local first, suffix = first:match ('(.-),?%s*([%dJS][%drndth]+)%.?$') or first; -- if first has something that looks like a generational suffix, get it
return false; -- abandon; boolean here to distinguish from nil fail returns later
end


local prefix_patterns_linked_t = { -- sequence of valid interwiki and inter project prefixen
if is_set (suffix) then
'^%[%[:([dsw]):(%l%l+):', -- wikilinked; project and language prefixes
if not is_suffix (suffix) then
'^%[%[:(%l%l+):([dsw]):', -- wikilinked; language and project prefixes
add_vanc_error ('suffix');
'^%[%[:([dsw]):', -- wikilinked; project prefix
return false; -- not a name with an appropriate suffix
'^%[%[:(%l%l+):', -- wikilinked; language prefix
}
local prefix_patterns_unlinked_t = { -- sequence of valid interwiki and inter project prefixen
'^:([dsw]):(%l%l+):', -- project and language prefixes
'^:(%l%l+):([dsw]):', -- language and project prefixes
'^:([dsw]):', -- project prefix
'^:(%l%l+):', -- language prefix
}
local cap1, cap2;
for _, pattern in ipairs ((is_link and prefix_patterns_linked_t) or prefix_patterns_unlinked_t) do
cap1, cap2 = value:match (pattern);
if cap1 then
break; -- found a match so stop looking
end
end
if cap1 and cap2 then -- when both then :project:language: or :language:project: (both forms allowed)
if 1 == #cap1 then -- length == 1 then :project:language:
if cfg.inter_wiki_map[cap2] then -- is language prefix in the interwiki map?
return cap1, cap2; -- return interwiki project and interwiki language
end
else -- here when :language:project:
if cfg.inter_wiki_map[cap1] then -- is language prefix in the interwiki map?
return cap2, cap1; -- return interwiki project and interwiki language
end
end
return nil; -- unknown interwiki language
elseif not (cap1 or cap2) then -- both are nil?
return nil; -- we got something that looks like a project prefix but isn't; return fail
elseif 1 == #cap1 then -- here when one capture
return cap1, nil; -- length is 1 so return project, nil language
else -- here when one capture and its length it more than 1
if cfg.inter_wiki_map[cap1] then -- is language prefix in the interwiki map?
return nil, cap1; -- return nil project, language
end
end
end
end
if nil == mw.ustring.find (last, "^[A-Za-z\195\128-\195\150\195\152-\195\182\195\184-\198\191\199\132-\201\143%-%s%']*$") or
nil == mw.ustring.find (first, "^[A-Za-z\195\128-\195\150\195\152-\195\182\195\184-\198\191\199\132-\201\143%-%s%'%.]*$") then
add_vanc_error ('non-Latin character');
return false; -- not a string of latin characters; Vancouver requires Romanization
end;
return true;
end
end




--[[--------------------------< L I S T _ P E O P L E >--------------------------
--[[--------------------------< R E D U C E _ T O _ I N I T I A L S >------------------------------------------
 
Attempts to convert names to initials in support of |name-list-format=vanc. 


Formats a list of people (authors, contributors, editors, interviewers, translators)
Names in |firstn= may be separated by spaces or hyphens, or for initials, a period. See http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35062/.


names in the list will be linked when
Vancouver style requires family rank designations (Jr, II, III, etc) to be rendered as Jr, 2nd, 3rd, etc.  See http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35085/.
|<name>-link= has a value
This code only accepts and understands generational suffix in the Vancouver format because Roman numerals look like, and can be mistaken for, initials.
|<name>-mask- does NOT have a value; masked names are presumed to have been
rendered previously so should have been linked there


when |<name>-mask=0, the associated name is not rendered
This function uses ustring functions because firstname initials may be any of the unicode Latin characters accepted by is_good_vanc_name ().


]]
]]


local function list_people (control, people, etal)
local function reduce_to_initials(first)
local sep;
local name, suffix = mw.ustring.match(first, "^(%u+) ([%dJS][%drndth]+)$");
local namesep;
local format = control.format;
local maximum = control.maximum;
local name_list = {};


if 'vanc' == format then -- Vancouver-like name styling?
if not name then -- if not initials and a suffix
sep = cfg.presentation['sep_nl_vanc']; -- name-list separator between names is a comma
name = mw.ustring.match(first, "^(%u+)$"); -- is it just intials?
namesep = cfg.presentation['sep_name_vanc']; -- last/first separator is a space
else
sep = cfg.presentation['sep_nl']; -- name-list separator between names is a semicolon
namesep = cfg.presentation['sep_name']; -- last/first separator is <comma><space>
end
end
if sep:sub (-1, -1) ~= " " then sep = sep .. " " end
if utilities.is_set (maximum) and maximum < 1 then return "", 0; end -- returned 0 is for EditorCount; not used for other names
for i, person in ipairs (people) do
if utilities.is_set (person.last) then
local mask = person.mask;
local one;
local sep_one = sep;


if utilities.is_set (maximum) and i > maximum then
if name then -- if first is initials with or without suffix
etal = true;
if 3 > mw.ustring.len (name) then -- if one or two initials
break;
if suffix then -- if there is a suffix
end
if is_suffix (suffix) then -- is it legitimate?
return first; -- one or two initials and a valid suffix so nothing to do
if mask then
local n = tonumber (mask); -- convert to a number if it can be converted; nil else
if n then
one = 0 ~= n and string.rep("&mdash;", n) or nil; -- make a string of (n > 0) mdashes, nil else, to replace name
person.link = nil; -- don't create link to name if name is replaces with mdash string or has been set nil
else
else
one = mask; -- replace name with mask text (must include name-list separator)
add_vanc_error ('suffix'); -- one or two initials with invalid suffix so error message
sep_one = " "; -- modify name-list separator
return first; -- and return first unmolested
end
end
else
else
one = person.last; -- get surname
return first; -- one or two initials without suffix; nothing to do
local first = person.first -- get given name
if utilities.is_set (first) then
if ("vanc" == format) then -- if Vancouver format
one = one:gsub ('%.', ''); -- remove periods from surnames (http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35029/)
if not person.corporate and is_good_vanc_name (one, first, nil, i) then -- and name is all Latin characters; corporate authors not tested
first = reduce_to_initials (first, i); -- attempt to convert first name(s) to initials
end
end
one = one .. namesep .. first;
end
end
if utilities.is_set (person.link) then
one = utilities.make_wikilink (person.link, one); -- link author/editor
end
end
end
end -- if here then name has 3 or more uppercase letters so treat them as a word


if one then -- if <one> has a value (name, mdash replacement, or mask text replacement)
local proj, tag = interwiki_prefixen_get (one, true); -- get the interwiki prefixen if present


if 'w' == proj and ('Wikipedia' == mw.site.namespaces.Project['name']) then
local initials, names = {}, {}; -- tables to hold name parts and initials
proj = nil; -- for stuff like :w:de:<article>, :w is unnecessary TODO: maint cat?
local i = 1; -- counter for number of initials
end
if proj then
proj = ({['d'] = 'Wikidata', ['s'] = 'Wikisource', ['w'] = 'Wikipedia'})[proj]; -- :w (wikipedia) for linking from a non-wikipedia project
if proj then
one = one .. utilities.wrap_style ('interproj', proj); -- add resized leading space, brackets, static text, language name
tag = nil; -- unset; don't do both project and language
end
end
if tag == cfg.this_wiki_code then
tag = nil; -- stuff like :en:<article> at en.wiki is pointless TODO: maint cat?
end
if tag then
local lang = cfg.lang_tag_remap[tag] or cfg.mw_languages_by_tag_t[tag];
if lang then -- error messaging done in extract_names() where we know parameter names
one = one .. utilities.wrap_style ('interwiki', lang); -- add resized leading space, brackets, static text, language name
end
end


table.insert (name_list, one); -- add it to the list of names
names = mw.text.split (first, '[%s,]+'); -- split into a table of names and possible suffix
table.insert (name_list, sep_one); -- add the proper name-list separator
end
end
end


local count = #name_list / 2; -- (number of names + number of separators) divided by 2
while names[i] do -- loop through the table
if 0 < count then
if 1 < i and names[i]:match ('[%dJS][%drndth]+%.?$') then -- if not the first name, and looks like a suffix (may have trailing dot)
if 1 < count and not etal then
names[i] = names[i]:gsub ('%.', ''); -- remove terminal dot if present
if 'amp' == format then
if is_suffix (names[i]) then -- if a legitimate suffix
name_list[#name_list-2] = " & "; -- replace last separator with ampersand text
table.insert (initials, ' ' .. names[i]); -- add a separator space, insert at end of initials table
elseif 'and' == format then
break; -- and done because suffix must fall at the end of a name
if 2 == count then
end -- no error message if not a suffix; possibly because of Romanization
name_list[#name_list-2] = cfg.presentation.sep_nl_and; -- replace last separator with 'and' text
end
else
if 3 > i then
name_list[#name_list-2] = cfg.presentation.sep_nl_end; -- replace last separator with '(sep) and' text
table.insert (initials, mw.ustring.sub(names[i],1,1)); -- insert the intial at end of initials table
end
end
end
end
name_list[#name_list] = nil; -- erase the last separator
i = i+1; -- bump the counter
end
end
 
local result = table.concat (name_list); -- construct list
return table.concat(initials) -- Vancouver format does not include spaces.
if etal and utilities.is_set (result) then -- etal may be set by |display-authors=etal but we might not have a last-first list
result = result .. sep .. cfg.messages['et al']; -- we've got a last-first list and etal so add et al.
end
return result, count; -- return name-list string and count of number of names (count used for editor names only)
end
end




--[[--------------------< M A K E _ C I T E R E F _ I D >-----------------------
--[[--------------------------< L I S T _ P E O P L E >-------------------------------------------------------
 
Generates a CITEREF anchor ID if we have at least one name or a date.  Otherwise
returns an empty string.


namelist is one of the contributor-, author-, or editor-name lists chosen in that
Formats a list of people (e.g. authors / editors)
order. year is Year or anchor_year.


]]
]]


local function make_citeref_id (namelist, year)
local function list_people(control, people, etal)
local names={}; -- a table for the one to four names and year
local sep;
for i,v in ipairs (namelist) do -- loop through the list and take up to the first four last names
local namesep;
names[i] = v.last
local format = control.format
if i == 4 then break end -- if four then done
local maximum = control.maximum
end
local lastauthoramp = control.lastauthoramp;
table.insert (names, year); -- add the year at the end
local text = {}
local id = table.concat(names); -- concatenate names and year for CITEREF id
if utilities.is_set (id) then -- if concatenation is not an empty string
return "CITEREF" .. id; -- add the CITEREF portion
else
return ''; -- return an empty string; no reason to include CITEREF id in this citation
end
end


 
if 'vanc' == format then -- Vancouver-like author/editor name styling?
--[[--------------------------< C I T E _ C L A S S _A T T R I B U T E _M A K E >------------------------------
sep = cfg.presentation['sep_nl_vanc']; -- name-list separator between authors is a comma
 
namesep = cfg.presentation['sep_name_vanc']; -- last/first separator is a space
construct <cite> tag class attribute for this citation.
 
<cite_class> – config.CitationClass from calling template
<mode> – value from |mode= parameter
 
]]
 
local function cite_class_attribute_make (cite_class, mode)
local class_t = {};
table.insert (class_t, 'citation'); -- required for blue highlight
if 'citation' ~= cite_class then
table.insert (class_t, cite_class); -- identify this template for user css
table.insert (class_t, utilities.is_set (mode) and mode or 'cs1'); -- identify the citation style for user css or javascript
else
else
table.insert (class_t, utilities.is_set (mode) and mode or 'cs2'); -- identify the citation style for user css or javascript
sep = cfg.presentation['sep_nl']; -- name-list separator between authors is a semicolon
namesep = cfg.presentation['sep_name']; -- last/first separator is <comma><space>
end
end
for _, prop_key in ipairs (z.prop_keys_t) do
table.insert (class_t, prop_key); -- identify various properties for user css or javascript
if sep:sub(-1,-1) ~= " " then sep = sep .. " " end
end
if is_set (maximum) and maximum < 1 then return "", 0; end -- returned 0 is for EditorCount; not used for authors
 
return table.concat (class_t, ' '); -- make a big string and done
for i,person in ipairs(people) do
end
if is_set(person.last) then
 
local mask = person.mask
 
local one
--[[---------------------< N A M E _ H A S _ E T A L >--------------------------
local sep_one = sep;
 
if is_set (maximum) and i > maximum then
Evaluates the content of name parameters (author, editor, etc.) for variations on
etal = true;
the theme of et al.  If found, the et al. is removed, a flag is set to true and
break;
the function returns the modified name and the flag.
elseif (mask ~= nil) then
 
local n = tonumber(mask)
This function never sets the flag to false but returns its previous state because
if (n ~= nil) then
it may have been set by previous passes through this function or by the associated
one = string.rep("&mdash;",n)
|display-<names>=etal parameter
else
 
one = mask;
]]
sep_one = " ";
 
end
local function name_has_etal (name, etal, nocat, param)
else
 
one = person.last
if utilities.is_set (name) then -- name can be nil in which case just return
local first = person.first
local patterns = cfg.et_al_patterns; -- get patterns from configuration
if is_set(first) then
if ( "vanc" == format ) then -- if vancouver format
for _, pattern in ipairs (patterns) do -- loop through all of the patterns
one = one:gsub ('%.', ''); -- remove periods from surnames (http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35029/)
if name:match (pattern) then -- if this 'et al' pattern is found in name
if not person.corporate and is_good_vanc_name (one, first) then -- and name is all Latin characters; corporate authors not tested
name = name:gsub (pattern, ''); -- remove the offending text
first = reduce_to_initials(first) -- attempt to convert first name(s) to initials
etal = true; -- set flag (may have been set previously here or by |display-<names>=etal)
end
if not nocat then -- no categorization for |vauthors=
end
utilities.set_message ('err_etal', {param}); -- and set an error if not added
one = one .. namesep .. first;
end
if is_set(person.link) and person.link ~= control.page_name then
one = make_wikilink (person.link, one); -- link author/editor if this page is not the author's/editor's page
end
end
end
end
table.insert( text, one )
table.insert( text, sep_one )
end
end
end
end


return name, etal;
local count = #text / 2; -- (number of names + number of separators) divided by 2
if count > 0 then
if count > 1 and is_set(lastauthoramp) and not etal then
text[#text-2] = " & "; -- replace last separator with ampersand text
end
text[#text] = nil; -- erase the last separator
end
local result = table.concat(text) -- construct list
if etal and is_set (result) then -- etal may be set by |display-authors=etal but we might not have a last-first list
result = result .. sep .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['et al']; -- we've go a last-first list and etal so add et al.
end
return result, count
end
end




--[[---------------------< N A M E _ I S _ N U M E R I C >----------------------
--[[--------------------------< A N C H O R _ I D >------------------------------------------------------------


Add maint cat when name parameter value does not contain lettersDoes not catch
Generates a CITEREF anchor ID if we have at least one name or a dateOtherwise returns an empty string.
mixed alphanumeric names so |last=A. Green (1922-1987) does not get caught in the
current version of this test but |first=(1888) is caught.


returns nothing
namelist is one of the contributor-, author-, or editor-name lists chosen in that order.  year is Year or anchor_year.


]]
]]
 
local function anchor_id (namelist, year)
local function name_is_numeric (name, list_name)
local names={}; -- a table for the one to four names and year
if utilities.is_set (name) then
for i,v in ipairs (namelist) do -- loop through the list and take up to the first four last names
if mw.ustring.match (name, '^[%A]+$') then -- when name does not contain any letters
names[i] = v.last
utilities.set_message ('maint_numeric_names', cfg.special_case_translation [list_name]); -- add a maint cat for this template
if i == 4 then break end -- if four then done
end
end
table.insert (names, year); -- add the year at the end
local id = table.concat(names); -- concatenate names and year for CITEREF id
if is_set (id) then -- if concatenation is not an empty string
return "CITEREF" .. id; -- add the CITEREF portion
else
return ''; -- return an empty string; no reason to include CITEREF id in this citation
end
end
end
end




--[[-----------------< N A M E _ H A S _ M U L T _ N A M E S >------------------
--[[--------------------------< N A M E _ H A S _ E T A L >----------------------------------------------------


Evaluates the content of last/surname (authors etc.) parameters for multiple names.
Evaluates the content of author and editor name parameters for variations on the theme of et al. If found,
Multiple names are indicated if there is more than one comma or any "unescaped"
the et al. is removed, a flag is set to true and the function returns the modified name and the flag.
semicolons. Escaped semicolons are ones used as part of selected HTML entities.
If the condition is met, the function adds the multiple name maintenance category.


Same test for first except that commas should not appear in given names (MOS:JR says
This function never sets the flag to false but returns it's previous state because it may have been set by
that the generational suffix does not take a separator character).  Titles, degrees,
previous passes through this function or by the parameters |display-authors=etal or |display-editors=etal
postnominals, affiliations, all normally comma separated don't belong in a citation.


<name> – name parameter value
]]
<list_name> – AuthorList, EditorList, etc
<limit> – number of allowed commas; 1 (default) for surnames; 0 for given names
 
returns nothing


]]
local function name_has_etal (name, etal, nocat)


local function name_has_mult_names (name, list_name, limit)
if is_set (name) then -- name can be nil in which case just return
local _, commas, semicolons, nbsps;
local etal_pattern = "[;,]? *[\"']*%f[%a][Ee][Tt] *[Aa][Ll][%.\"']*$" -- variations on the 'et al' theme
limit = limit and limit or 1;
local others_pattern = "[;,]? *%f[%a]and [Oo]thers"; -- and alternate to et al.
if utilities.is_set (name) then
_, commas = name:gsub (',', ''); -- count the number of commas
_, semicolons = name:gsub (';', ''); -- count the number of semicolons
-- nbsps probably should be its own separate count rather than merged in
-- some way with semicolons because Lua patterns do not support the
-- grouping operator that regex does, which means there is no way to add
-- more entities to escape except by adding more counts with the new
-- entities
_, nbsps = name:gsub ('&nbsp;',''); -- count nbsps
-- There is exactly 1 semicolon per &nbsp; entity, so subtract nbsps
if name:match (etal_pattern) then -- variants on et al.
-- from semicolons to 'escape' them. If additional entities are added,
name = name:gsub (etal_pattern, ''); -- if found, remove
-- they also can be subtracted.
etal = true; -- set flag (may have been set previously here or by |display-authors=etal)
if limit < commas or 0 < (semicolons - nbsps) then
if not nocat then -- no categorization for |vauthors=
utilities.set_message ('maint_mult_names', cfg.special_case_translation [list_name]); -- add a maint message
add_maint_cat ('etal'); -- and add a category if not already added
end
elseif name:match (others_pattern) then -- if not 'et al.', then 'and others'?
name = name:gsub (others_pattern, ''); -- if found, remove
etal = true; -- set flag (may have been set previously here or by |display-authors=etal)
if not nocat then -- no categorization for |vauthors=
add_maint_cat ('etal'); -- and add a category if not already added
end
end
end
end
end
return name, etal; --
end
end




--[=[-------------------------< I S _ G E N E R I C >----------------------------------------------------------
--[[--------------------------< N A M E _ H A S _ E D _ M A R K U P >------------------------------------------


Compares values assigned to various parameters according to the string provided as <item> in the function call.
Evaluates the content of author and editor parameters for extranious editor annotations: ed, ed., eds, (Ed.), etc.
<item> can have on of two values:
These annotation do not belong in author parameters and are redundant in editor parameters.  If found, the function
'generic_names' – for name-holding parameters: |last=, |first=, |editor-last=, etc
adds the editor markup maintenance category.
'generic_titles' – for |title=


There are two types of generic tests.  The 'accept' tests look for a pattern that should not be rejected by the
]]
'reject' test.  For example,
|author=[[John Smith (author)|Smith, John]]
would be rejected by the 'author' reject test.  But piped wikilinks with 'author' disambiguation should not be
rejected so the 'accept' test prevents that from happening.  Accept tests are always performed before reject
tests.


Each of the 'accept' and 'reject' sequence tables hold tables for en.wiki (['en']) and local.wiki (['local'])
local function name_has_ed_markup (name, list_name)
that each can hold a test sequence table  The sequence table holds, at index [1], a test pattern, and, at index
local _, pattern;
[2], a boolean control value.  The control value tells string.find() or mw.ustring.find() to do plain-text search (true)
local patterns = { -- these patterns match annotations at end of name
or a pattern search (false).  The intent of all this complexity is to make these searches as fast as possible so
'%f[%(%[][%(%[]%s*[Ee][Dd][Ss]?%.?%s*[%)%]]?$', -- (ed) or (eds): leading '(', case insensitive 'ed', optional 's', '.' and/or ')'
that we don't run out of processing time on very large articles.
'[,%.%s]%f[e]eds?%.?$', -- ed or eds: without '('or ')'; case sensitive (ED could be initials Ed could be name)
 
'%f[%(%[][%(%[]%s*[Ee][Dd][Ii][Tt][Oo][Rr][Ss]?%.?%s*[%)%]]?$', -- (editor) or (editors): leading '(', case insensitive, optional '.' and/or ')'
Returns
'[,%.%s]%f[Ee][Ee][Dd][Ii][Tt][Oo][Rr][Ss]?%.?$', -- editor or editors: without '('or ')'; case insensitive
true when a reject test finds the pattern or string
false when an accept test finds the pattern or string
-- these patterns match annotations at beginning of name
nil else
'^eds?[%.,;]', -- ed. or eds.: lower case only, optional 's', requires '.'
 
'^[%(%[]%s*[Ee][Dd][Ss]?%.?%s*[%)%]]', -- (ed) or (eds): also sqare brackets, case insensitive, optional 's', '.'
]=]
'^[%(%[]?%s*[Ee][Dd][Ii][Tt][Oo][Rr][Ss]?%A', -- (editor or (editors: also sq brackets, case insensitive, optional brackets, 's'
 
'^[%(%[]?%s*[Ee][Dd][Ii][Tt][Ee][Dd]%A', -- (edited: also sq brackets, case insensitive, optional brackets
local function is_generic (item, value, wiki)
local test_val;
local str_lower = { -- use string.lower() for en.wiki (['en']) and use mw.ustring.lower() or local.wiki (['local'])
['en'] = string.lower,
['local'] = mw.ustring.lower,
}
local str_find = { -- use string.find() for en.wiki (['en']) and use mw.ustring.find() or local.wiki (['local'])
['en'] = string.find,
['local'] = mw.ustring.find,
}
}


local function test (val, test_t, wiki) -- local function to do the testing; <wiki> selects lower() and find() functions
if is_set (name) then
val = test_t[2] and str_lower[wiki](value) or val; -- when <test_t[2]> set to 'true', plaintext search using lowercase value
for _, pattern in ipairs (patterns) do -- spin through patterns table and
return str_find[wiki] (val, test_t[1], 1, test_t[2]); -- return nil when not found or matched
if name:match (pattern) then
end
add_maint_cat ('extra_text_names', cfg.special_case_translation [list_name]); -- add a maint cat for this template
break;
local test_types_t = {'accept', 'reject'}; -- test accept patterns first, then reject patterns
local wikis_t = {'en', 'local'}; -- do tests for each of these keys; en.wiki first, local.wiki second
 
for _, test_type in ipairs (test_types_t) do -- for each test type
for _, generic_value in pairs (cfg.special_case_translation[item][test_type]) do -- spin through the list of generic value fragments to accept or reject
for _, wiki in ipairs (wikis_t) do
if generic_value[wiki] then
if test (value, generic_value[wiki], wiki) then -- go do the test
return ('reject' == test_type); -- param value rejected, return true; false else
end
end
end
end
end
end
end
end
return name; -- and done
end
end




--[[--------------------------< N A M E _ I S _ G E N E R I C >------------------------------------------------
--[[--------------------------< N A M E _ H A S _ M U L T _ N A M E S >----------------------------------------


calls is_generic() to determine if <name> is a 'generic name' listed in cfg.generic_names; <name_alias> is the
Evaluates the content of author and editor (surnames only) parameters for multiple names.  Multiple names are
parameter name used in error messaging
indicated if there is more than one comma and or semicolon. If found, the function adds the multiple name
(author or editor) maintenance category.


]]
]]


local function name_is_generic (name, name_alias)
local function name_has_mult_names (name, list_name)
if not added_generic_name_errs  and is_generic ('generic_names', name) then
local count, _;
utilities.set_message ('err_generic_name', name_alias); -- set an error message
if is_set (name) then
added_generic_name_errs = true;
_, count = name:gsub ('[;,]', ''); -- count the number of separator-like characters
if 1 < count then -- param could be |author= or |editor= so one separator character is acceptable
add_maint_cat ('mult_names', cfg.special_case_translation [list_name]); -- more than one separator indicates multiple names so add a maint cat for this template
end
end
end
return name; -- and done
end
end




--[[--------------------------< N A M E _ C H E C K S >--------------------------------------------------------
--[[--------------------------< N A M E _ C H E C K S >--------------------------------------------------------
 
This function calls various name checking functions used to validate the content of the various name-holding
This function calls various name checking functions used to validate the content of the various name-holding parameters.
parameters.


]]
]]


local function name_checks (last, first, list_name, last_alias, first_alias)
local function name_checks (last, first, list_name)
local accept_name;
if is_set (last) then
 
if last:match ('^%(%(.*%)%)$') then -- if wrapped in doubled parentheses, accept as written  
if utilities.is_set (last) then
last = last:match ('^%(%((.*)%)%)$'); -- strip parens
last, accept_name = utilities.has_accept_as_written (last); -- remove accept-this-as-written markup when it wraps all of <last>
else
 
last = name_has_mult_names (last, list_name); -- check for multiple names in the parameter (last only)
if not accept_name then -- <last> not wrapped in accept-as-written markup
last = name_has_ed_markup (last, list_name); -- check for extraneous 'editor' annotation
name_has_mult_names (last, list_name); -- check for multiple names in the parameter
name_is_numeric (last, list_name); -- check for names that are composed of digits and punctuation
name_is_generic (last, last_alias); -- check for names found in the generic names list
end
end
end
end
 
if is_set (first) then
if utilities.is_set (first) then
if first:match ('^%(%(.*%)%)$') then -- if wrapped in doubled parentheses, accept as written  
first, accept_name = utilities.has_accept_as_written (first); -- remove accept-this-as-written markup when it wraps all of <first>
first = first:match ('^%(%((.*)%)%)$'); -- strip parens
 
else
if not accept_name then -- <first> not wrapped in accept-as-written markup
first = name_has_ed_markup (first, list_name); -- check for extraneous 'editor' annotation
name_has_mult_names (first, list_name, 0); -- check for multiple names in the parameter; 0 is number of allowed commas in a given name
name_is_numeric (first, list_name); -- check for names that are composed of digits and punctuation
name_is_generic (first, first_alias); -- check for names found in the generic names list
end
local wl_type, D = utilities.is_wikilink (first);
if 0 ~= wl_type then
first = D;
utilities.set_message ('err_bad_paramlink', first_alias);
end
end
end
end
return last, first; -- done
return last, first; -- done
end
end
 


--[[----------------------< E X T R A C T _ N A M E S >-------------------------


--[[--------------------------< E X T R A C T _ N A M E S >----------------------------------------------------
Gets name list from the input arguments
Gets name list from the input arguments


Searches through args in sequential order to find |lastn= and |firstn= parameters
Searches through args in sequential order to find |lastn= and |firstn= parameters (or their aliases), and their matching link and mask parameters.
(or their aliases), and their matching link and mask parameters. Stops searching
Stops searching when both |lastn= and |firstn= are not found in args after two sequential attempts: found |last1=, |last2=, and |last3= but doesn't
when both |lastn= and |firstn= are not found in args after two sequential attempts:
find |last4= and |last5= then the search is done.
found |last1=, |last2=, and |last3= but doesn't find |last4= and |last5= then the
search is done.


This function emits an error message when there is a |firstn= without a matching
This function emits an error message when there is a |firstn= without a matching |lastn=.  When there are 'holes' in the list of last names, |last1= and |last3=
|lastn=.  When there are 'holes' in the list of last names, |last1= and |last3=
are present but |last2= is missing, an error message is emitted. |lastn= is not required to have a matching |firstn=.
are present but |last2= is missing, an error message is emitted. |lastn= is not
required to have a matching |firstn=.


When an author or editor parameter contains some form of 'et al.', the 'et al.'
When an author or editor parameter contains some form of 'et al.', the 'et al.' is stripped from the parameter and a flag (etal) returned
is stripped from the parameter and a flag (etal) returned that will cause list_people()
that will cause list_people() to add the static 'et al.' text from Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration.  This keeps 'et al.' out of the  
to add the static 'et al.' text from Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration.  This keeps
template's metadata.  When this occurs, the page is added to a maintenance category.
'et al.' out of the template's metadata.  When this occurs, an error is emitted.


]]
]]


local function extract_names(args, list_name)
local function extract_names(args, list_name)
local names = {}; -- table of names
local names = {}; -- table of names
local last; -- individual name components
local last; -- individual name components
local first;
local first;
local link;
local link;
local mask;
local mask;
local i = 1; -- loop counter/indexer
local i = 1; -- loop counter/indexer
local n = 1; -- output table indexer
local n = 1; -- output table indexer
local count = 0; -- used to count the number of times we haven't found a |last= (or alias for authors, |editor-last or alias for editors)
local count = 0; -- used to count the number of times we haven't found a |last= (or alias for authors, |editor-last or alias for editors)
local etal = false; -- return value set to true when we find some form of et al. in an author parameter
local etal=false; -- return value set to true when we find some form of et al. in an author parameter


local last_alias, first_alias, link_alias; -- selected parameter aliases used in error messaging
local err_msg_list_name = list_name:match ("(%w+)List") .. 's list'; -- modify AuthorList or EditorList for use in error messages if necessary
while true do
while true do
last, last_alias = utilities.select_one ( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Last'], 'err_redundant_parameters', i ); -- search through args for name components beginning at 1
last = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Last'], 'redundant_parameters', i ); -- search through args for name components beginning at 1
first, first_alias = utilities.select_one ( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-First'], 'err_redundant_parameters', i );
first = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-First'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
link, link_alias = utilities.select_one ( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Link'], 'err_redundant_parameters', i );
link = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Link'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
mask = utilities.select_one ( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Mask'], 'err_redundant_parameters', i );
mask = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Mask'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
 
if last then -- error check |lastn= alias for unknown interwiki link prefix; done here because this is where we have the parameter name
last, etal = name_has_etal (last, etal, false); -- find and remove variations on et al.
local project, language = interwiki_prefixen_get (last, true); -- true because we expect interwiki links in |lastn= to be wikilinked
first, etal = name_has_etal (first, etal, false); -- find and remove variations on et al.
if nil == project and nil == language then -- when both are nil
last, first= name_checks (last, first, list_name); -- multiple names, extraneous annotation, etc checks
utilities.set_message ('err_bad_paramlink', last_alias); -- not known, emit an error message -- TODO: err_bad_interwiki?
last = utilities.remove_wiki_link (last); -- remove wikilink markup; show display value only
end
end
if link then -- error check |linkn= alias for unknown interwiki link prefix
local project, language = interwiki_prefixen_get (link, false); -- false because wiki links in |author-linkn= is an error
if nil == project and nil == language then -- when both are nil
utilities.set_message ('err_bad_paramlink', link_alias); -- not known, emit an error message -- TODO: err_bad_interwiki?
link = nil; -- unset so we don't link
link_alias = nil;
end
end
last, etal = name_has_etal (last, etal, false, last_alias); -- find and remove variations on et al.
first, etal = name_has_etal (first, etal, false, first_alias); -- find and remove variations on et al.
last, first = name_checks (last, first, list_name, last_alias, first_alias); -- multiple names, extraneous annotation, etc. checks
 
if first and not last then -- if there is a firstn without a matching lastn
if first and not last then -- if there is a firstn without a matching lastn
local alias = first_alias:find ('given', 1, true) and 'given' or 'first'; -- get first or given form of the alias
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'first_missing_last', {err_msg_list_name, i}, true ) } ); -- add this error message
utilities.set_message ('err_first_missing_last', {
first_alias, -- param name of alias missing its mate
first_alias:gsub (alias, {['first'] = 'last', ['given'] = 'surname'}), -- make param name appropriate to the alias form
}); -- add this error message
elseif not first and not last then -- if both firstn and lastn aren't found, are we done?
elseif not first and not last then -- if both firstn and lastn aren't found, are we done?
count = count + 1; -- number of times we haven't found last and first
count = count + 1; -- number of times we haven't found last and first
Baris 1.628: Baris 1.361:
end
end
else -- we have last with or without a first
else -- we have last with or without a first
local result;
link_title_ok (link, list_name:match ("(%w+)List"):lower() .. '-link' .. i, last, list_name:match ("(%w+)List"):lower() .. '-last' .. i); -- check for improper wikimarkup
link = link_title_ok (link, link_alias, last, last_alias); -- check for improper wiki-markup
 
if first then
link = link_title_ok (link, link_alias, first, first_alias); -- check for improper wiki-markup
end


names[n] = {last = last, first = first, link = link, mask = mask, corporate = false}; -- add this name to our names list (corporate for |vauthors= only)
names[n] = {last = last, first = first, link = link, mask = mask, corporate=false}; -- add this name to our names list (corporate for |vauthors= only)
n = n + 1; -- point to next location in the names table
n = n + 1; -- point to next location in the names table
if 1 == count then -- if the previous name was missing
if 1 == count then -- if the previous name was missing
utilities.set_message ('err_missing_name', {list_name:match ("(%w+)List"):lower(), i - 1}); -- add this error message
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'missing_name', {err_msg_list_name, i-1}, true ) } ); -- add this error message
end
end
count = 0; -- reset the counter, we're looking for two consecutive missing names
count = 0; -- reset the counter, we're looking for two consecutive missing names
Baris 1.645: Baris 1.373:
end
end
return names, etal; -- all done, return our list of names and the etal flag
return names, etal; -- all done, return our list of names
end
end




--[[--------------------------< N A M E _ T A G _ G E T >------------------------------------------------------
--[[--------------------------< G E T _ I S O 6 3 9 _ C O D E >------------------------------------------------
 
attempt to decode |language=<lang_param> and return language name and matching tag; nil else.


This function looks for:
Validates language names provided in |language= parameter if not an ISO639-1 or 639-2 code.
<lang_param> as a tag in cfg.lang_tag_remap{}
<lang_param> as a name in cfg.lang_name_remap{}
<lang_param> as a name in cfg.mw_languages_by_name_t
<lang_param> as a tag in cfg.mw_languages_by_tag_t
when those fail, presume that <lang_param> is an IETF-like tag that MediaWiki does not recognize.  Strip all
script, region, variant, whatever subtags from <lang_param> to leave just a two or three character language tag
and look for the new <lang_param> in cfg.mw_languages_by_tag_t{}


on success, returns name (in properly capitalized form) and matching tag (in lowercase); on failure returns nil
Returns the language name and associated two- or three-character code.  Because case of the source may be incorrect
or different from the case that WikiMedia uses, the name comparisons are done in lower case and when a match is
found, the Wikimedia version (assumed to be correct) is returned along with the code.  When there is no match, we
return the original language name string.


]]
mw.language.fetchLanguageNames(<local wiki language>, 'all') returns a list of languages that in some cases may include
extensions. For example, code 'cbk-zam' and its associated name 'Chavacano de Zamboanga' (MediaWiki does not support
code 'cbk' or name 'Chavacano'.  Most (all?) of these languages are not used a 'language' codes per se, rather they
are used as sub-domain names: cbk-zam.wikipedia.org.  These names can be found (for the time being) at
https://phabricator.wikimedia.org/diffusion/ECLD/browse/master/LocalNames/LocalNamesEn.php


local function name_tag_get (lang_param)
Names but that are included in the list will be found if that name is provided in the |language= parameter.  For example,
local lang_param_lc = mw.ustring.lower (lang_param); -- use lowercase as an index into the various tables
if |language=Chavacano de Zamboanga, that name will be found with the associated code 'cbk-zam'. When names are found
local name;
and the associated code is not two or three characters, this function returns only the Wikimedia language name.
local tag;


name = cfg.lang_tag_remap[lang_param_lc]; -- assume <lang_param_lc> is a tag; attempt to get remapped language name
Adapted from code taken from Module:Check ISO 639-1.
if name then -- when <name>, <lang_param> is a tag for a remapped language name
return name, lang_param_lc; -- so return <name> from remap and <lang_param_lc>
end


tag = lang_param_lc:match ('^(%a%a%a?)%-.*'); -- still assuming that <lang_param_lc> is a tag; strip script, region, variant subtags
]]
name = cfg.lang_tag_remap[tag]; -- attempt to get remapped language name with language subtag only
if name then -- when <name>, <tag> is a tag for a remapped language name
return name, tag; -- so return <name> from remap and <tag>
end


if cfg.lang_name_remap[lang_param_lc] then -- not a tag, assume <lang_param_lc> is a name; attempt to get remapped language tag
local function get_iso639_code (lang, this_wiki_code)
return cfg.lang_name_remap[lang_param_lc][1], cfg.lang_name_remap[lang_param_lc][2]; -- for this <lang_param_lc>, return a (possibly) new name and appropriate tag
if cfg.lang_name_remap[lang:lower()] then -- if there is a remapped name (because MediaWiki uses something that we don't think is correct)
return cfg.lang_name_remap[lang:lower()][1], cfg.lang_name_remap[lang:lower()][2]; -- for this language 'name', return a possibly new name and appropriate code
end
end


tag = cfg.mw_languages_by_name_t[lang_param_lc]; -- assume that <lang_param_lc> is a language name; attempt to get its matching tag
local languages = mw.language.fetchLanguageNames(this_wiki_code, 'all') -- get a list of language names known to Wikimedia
-- ('all' is required for North Ndebele, South Ndebele, and Ojibwa)
local langlc = mw.ustring.lower(lang); -- lower case version for comparisons
if tag then
for code, name in pairs(languages) do -- scan the list to see if we can find our language
return cfg.mw_languages_by_tag_t[tag], tag; -- <lang_param_lc> is a name so return the name from the table and <tag>
if langlc == mw.ustring.lower(name) then
end
if 2 ~= code:len() and 3 ~= code:len() then -- two- or three-character codes only; extensions not supported
 
return name; -- so return the name but not the code
name = cfg.mw_languages_by_tag_t[lang_param_lc]; -- assume that <lang_param_lc> is a tag; attempt to get its matching language name
end
return name, code; -- found it, return name to ensure proper capitalization and the the code
if name then
return name, lang_param_lc; -- <lang_param_lc> is a tag so return it and <name>
end
tag = lang_param_lc:match ('^(%a%a%a?)%-.*'); -- is <lang_param_lc> an IETF-like tag that MediaWiki doesn't recognize? <tag> gets the language subtag; nil else
 
if tag then
name = cfg.mw_languages_by_tag_t[tag]; -- attempt to get a language name using the shortened <tag>
if name then
return name, tag; -- <lang_param_lc> is an unrecognized IETF-like tag so return <name> and language subtag
end
end
end
end
return lang; -- not valid language; return language in original case and nil for the code
end
end




--[[-------------------< L A N G U A G E _ P A R A M E T E R >------------------
--[[--------------------------< L A N G U A G E _ P A R A M E T E R >------------------------------------------


Gets language name from a provided two- or three-character ISO 639 code.  If a code
Gets language name from a provided two- or three-character ISO 639 code.  If a code is recognized by MediaWiki,
is recognized by MediaWiki, use the returned name; if not, then use the value that
use the returned name; if not, then use the value that was provided with the language parameter.
was provided with the language parameter.


When |language= contains a recognized language (either code or name), the page is
When |language= contains a recognized language (either code or name), the page is assigned to the category for
assigned to the category for that code: Category:Norwegian-language sources (no).
that code: Category:Norwegian-language sources (no). For valid three-character code languages, the page is assigned
For valid three-character code languages, the page is assigned to the single category
to the single category for '639-2' codes: Category:CS1 ISO 639-2 language sources.
for '639-2' codes: Category:CS1 ISO 639-2 language sources.


Languages that are the same as the local wiki are not categorized.  MediaWiki does
Languages that are the same as the local wiki are not categorized.  MediaWiki does not recognize three-character
not recognize three-character equivalents of two-character codes: code 'ar' is
equivalents of two-character codes: code 'ar' is recognized bit code 'ara' is not.
recognized but code 'ara' is not.


This function supports multiple languages in the form |language=nb, French, th
This function supports multiple languages in the form |language=nb, French, th where the language names or codes are
where the language names or codes are separated from each other by commas with
separated from each other by commas.
optional space characters.


]]
]]


local function language_parameter (lang)
local function language_parameter (lang)
local tag; -- some form of IETF-like language tag; language subtag with optional region, sript, vatiant, etc subtags
local code; -- the two- or three-character language code
local lang_subtag; -- ve populates |language= with mostly unecessary region subtags the MediaWiki does not recognize; this is the base language subtag
local name; -- the language name
local name; -- the language name
local language_list = {}; -- table of language names to be rendered
local language_list = {}; -- table of language names to be rendered
local names_t = {}; -- table made from the value assigned to |language=
local names_table = {}; -- table made from the value assigned to |language=


local this_wiki_name = mw.language.fetchLanguageName (cfg.this_wiki_code, cfg.this_wiki_code); -- get this wiki's language name
local this_wiki = mw.getContentLanguage(); -- get a language object for this wiki
local this_wiki_code = this_wiki:getCode() -- get this wiki's language code
local this_wiki_name = mw.language.fetchLanguageName(this_wiki_code, this_wiki_code); -- get this wiki's language name


names_t = mw.text.split (lang, '%s*,%s*'); -- names should be a comma separated list
names_table = mw.text.split (lang, '%s*,%s*'); -- names should be a comma separated list


for _, lang in ipairs (names_t) do -- reuse lang here because we don't yet know if lang is a language name or a language tag
for _, lang in ipairs (names_table) do -- reuse lang
name, tag = name_tag_get (lang); -- attempt to get name/tag pair for <lang>; <name> has proper capitalization; <tag> is lowercase


if utilities.is_set (tag) then
if lang:match ('^%a%a%-') then -- strip ietf language tags from code; TODO: is there a need to support 3-char with tag?
lang_subtag = tag:gsub ('^(%a%a%a?)%-.*', '%1'); -- for categorization, strip any IETF-like tags from language tag
lang = lang:match ('(%a%a)%-') -- keep only 639-1 code portion to lang; TODO: do something with 3166 alpha 2 country code?
end
if 2 == lang:len() or 3 == lang:len() then -- if two-or three-character code
name = mw.language.fetchLanguageName( lang:lower(), this_wiki_code); -- get language name if |language= is a proper code
if not is_set (name) then
name = cfg.lang_code_remap[lang]; -- not supported by MediaWiki; is it in remap?
end
end
if is_set (name) then -- if |language= specified a valid code
code = lang:lower(); -- save it
else
name, code = get_iso639_code (lang, this_wiki_code); -- attempt to get code from name (assign name here so that we are sure of proper capitalization)
end
if is_set (code) then -- only 2- or 3-character codes
name = cfg.lang_code_remap[code] or name; -- override wikimedia when they misuse language codes/names


if cfg.this_wiki_code ~= lang_subtag then -- when the language is not the same as this wiki's language
if this_wiki_code ~= code then -- when the language is not the same as this wiki's language
if 2 == lang_subtag:len() then -- and is a two-character tag
if 2 == code:len() then -- and is a two-character code
utilities.add_prop_cat ('foreign-lang-source', {name, tag}, lang_subtag); -- categorize it; tag appended to allow for multiple language categorization
add_prop_cat ('foreign_lang_source' .. code, {name, code}) -- categorize it
else -- or is a recognized language (but has a three-character tag)
else -- or is a recognized language (but has a three-character code)
utilities.add_prop_cat ('foreign-lang-source-2', {lang_subtag}, lang_subtag); -- categorize it differently TODO: support multiple three-character tag categories per cs1|2 template?
add_prop_cat ('foreign_lang_source_2' .. code, {code}) -- categorize it differently TODO: support mutliple three-character code categories per cs1|2 template
end
end
elseif cfg.local_lang_cat_enable then -- when the language and this wiki's language are the same and categorization is enabled
utilities.add_prop_cat ('local-lang-source', {name, lang_subtag}); -- categorize it
end
end
else
else
name = lang; -- return whatever <lang> has so that we show something
add_maint_cat ('unknown_lang'); -- add maint category if not already added
utilities.set_message ('maint_unknown_lang'); -- add maint category if not already added
end
end
Baris 1.765: Baris 1.485:
name = ''; -- so we can reuse it
name = ''; -- so we can reuse it
end
end
name = utilities.make_sep_list (#language_list, language_list);
code = #language_list -- reuse code as number of languages in the list
if (1 == #language_list) and (lang_subtag == cfg.this_wiki_code) then -- when only one language, find lang name in this wiki lang name; for |language=en-us, 'English' in 'American English'
if 2 >= code then
name = table.concat (language_list, ' and ') -- insert '<space>and<space>' between two language names
elseif 2 < code then
language_list[code] = 'and ' .. language_list[code]; -- prepend last name with 'and<space>'
name = table.concat (language_list, ', ') -- and concatenate with '<comma><space>' separators
end
if this_wiki_name == name then
return ''; -- if one language and that language is this wiki's return an empty string (no annotation)
return ''; -- if one language and that language is this wiki's return an empty string (no annotation)
end
end
Baris 1.777: Baris 1.503:




--[[-----------------------< S E T _ C S _ S T Y L E >--------------------------
--[[--------------------------< S E T _ C S 1 _ S T Y L E >----------------------------------------------------
 
Set style settings for CS1 citation templates. Returns separator and postscript settings
At en.wiki, for cs1:
ps gets: '.'
sep gets: '.'
 
]]
 
local function set_cs1_style (ps)
if not is_set (ps) then -- unless explicitely set to something
ps = cfg.presentation['ps_cs1']; -- terminate the rendered citation
end
return cfg.presentation['sep_cs1'], ps; -- element separator
end
 
 
--[[--------------------------< S E T _ C S 2 _ S T Y L E >----------------------------------------------------


Gets the default CS style configuration for the given mode.
Set style settings for CS2 citation templates. Returns separator, postscript, ref settings
Returns default separator and either postscript as passed in or the default.
At en.wiki, for cs2:
In CS1, the default postscript and separator are '.'.
ps gets: '' (empty string - no terminal punctuation)
In CS2, the default postscript is the empty string and the default separator is ','.
sep gets: ','


]]
]]


local function set_cs_style (postscript, mode)
local function set_cs2_style (ps, ref)
if utilities.is_set(postscript) then
if not is_set (ps) then -- if |postscript= has not been set, set cs2 default
-- emit a maintenance message if user postscript is the default cs1 postscript
ps = cfg.presentation['ps_cs2']; -- terminate the rendered citation
-- we catch the opposite case for cs2 in set_style
end
if mode == 'cs1' and postscript == cfg.presentation['ps_' .. mode] then
if not is_set (ref) then -- if |ref= is not set
utilities.set_message ('maint_postscript');
ref = "harv"; -- set default |ref=harv
end
else
postscript = cfg.presentation['ps_' .. mode];
end
end
return cfg.presentation['sep_' .. mode], postscript;
return cfg.presentation['sep_cs2'], ps, ref; -- element separator
end
end




--[[--------------------------< S E T _ S T Y L E >-----------------------------
--[[--------------------------< G E T _ S E T T I N G S _ F R O M _ C I T E _ C L A S S >----------------------


Sets the separator and postscript styles. Checks the |mode= first and the
When |mode= is not set or when its value is invalid, use config.CitationClass and parameter values to establish
#invoke CitationClass second. Removes the postscript if postscript == none.
rendered style.


]]
]]


local function set_style (mode, postscript, cite_class)
local function get_settings_from_cite_class (ps, ref, cite_class)
local sep;
local sep;
if 'cs2' == mode then
if (cite_class == "citation") then -- for citation templates (CS2)
sep, postscript = set_cs_style (postscript, 'cs2');
sep, ps, ref = set_cs2_style (ps, ref);
elseif 'cs1' == mode then
else -- not a citation template so CS1
sep, postscript = set_cs_style (postscript, 'cs1');
sep, ps = set_cs1_style (ps);
elseif 'citation' == cite_class then
sep, postscript = set_cs_style (postscript, 'cs2');
else
sep, postscript = set_cs_style (postscript, 'cs1');
end
end


if cfg.keywords_xlate[postscript:lower()] == 'none' then
return sep, ps, ref -- return them all
-- emit a maintenance message if user postscript is the default cs2 postscript
end
-- we catch the opposite case for cs1 in set_cs_style
 
if 'cs2' == mode or 'citation' == cite_class then
 
utilities.set_message ('maint_postscript');
--[[--------------------------< S E T _ S T Y L E >------------------------------------------------------------
end
 
postscript = '';
Establish basic style settings to be used when rendering the citation.  Uses |mode= if set and valid or uses
config.CitationClass from the template's #invoke: to establish style.
 
]]
 
local function set_style (mode, ps, ref, cite_class)
local sep;
if 'cs2' == mode then -- if this template is to be rendered in CS2 (citation) style
sep, ps, ref = set_cs2_style (ps, ref);
elseif 'cs1' == mode then -- if this template is to be rendered in CS1 (cite xxx) style
sep, ps = set_cs1_style (ps);
else -- anything but cs1 or cs2
sep, ps, ref = get_settings_from_cite_class (ps, ref, cite_class); -- get settings based on the template's CitationClass
end
if 'none' == ps:lower() then -- if assigned value is 'none' then
ps = ''; -- set to empty string
end
end
return sep, postscript
return sep, ps, ref
end
end




--[=[-------------------------< I S _ P D F >-----------------------------------
--[=[-------------------------< I S _ P D F >------------------------------------------------------------------


Determines if a URL has the file extension that is one of the PDF file extensions
Determines if a url has the file extension that is one of the pdf file extensions used by [[MediaWiki:Common.css]] when
used by [[MediaWiki:Common.css]] when applying the PDF icon to external links.
applying the pdf icon to external links.


returns true if file extension is one of the recognized extensions, else false
returns true if file extension is one of the recognized extensions, else false
Baris 1.842: Baris 1.593:


local function is_pdf (url)
local function is_pdf (url)
return url:match ('%.pdf$') or url:match ('%.PDF$') or
return url:match ('%.pdf$') or url:match ('%.PDF$') or url:match ('%.pdf[%?#]') or url:match ('%.PDF[%?#]');
url:match ('%.pdf[%?#]') or url:match ('%.PDF[%?#]') or
url:match ('%.PDF&#035') or url:match ('%.pdf&#035');
end
end




--[[--------------------------< S T Y L E _ F O R M A T >-----------------------
--[[--------------------------< S T Y L E _ F O R M A T >------------------------------------------------------


Applies CSS style to |format=, |chapter-format=, etc.  Also emits an error message
Applies css style to |format=, |chapter-format=, etc.  Also emits an error message if the format parameter does
if the format parameter does not have a matching URL parameter.  If the format parameter
not have a matching url parameter.  If the format parameter is not set and the url contains a file extension that
is not set and the URL contains a file extension that is recognized as a PDF document
is recognized as a pdf document by MediaWiki's commons.css, this code will set the format parameter to (PDF) with
by MediaWiki's commons.css, this code will set the format parameter to (PDF) with
the appropriate styling.
the appropriate styling.


Baris 1.859: Baris 1.607:


local function style_format (format, url, fmt_param, url_param)
local function style_format (format, url, fmt_param, url_param)
if utilities.is_set (format) then
if is_set (format) then
format = utilities.wrap_style ('format', format); -- add leading space, parentheses, resize
format = wrap_style ('format', format); -- add leading space, parentheses, resize
if not utilities.is_set (url) then
if not is_set (url) then
utilities.set_message ('err_format_missing_url', {fmt_param, url_param}); -- add an error message
format = format .. set_error( 'format_missing_url', {fmt_param, url_param} ); -- add an error message
end
end
elseif is_pdf (url) then -- format is not set so if URL is a PDF file then
elseif is_pdf (url) then -- format is not set so if url is a pdf file then
format = utilities.wrap_style ('format', 'PDF'); -- set format to PDF
format = wrap_style ('format', 'PDF'); -- set format to pdf
else
else
format = ''; -- empty string for concatenation
format = ''; -- empty string for concatenation
Baris 1.873: Baris 1.621:




--[[---------------------< G E T _ D I S P L A Y _ N A M E S >------------------
--[[--------------------------< G E T _ D I S P L A Y _ A U T H O R S _ E D I T O R S >------------------------


Returns a number that defines the number of names displayed for author and editor
Returns a number that defines the number of names displayed for author and editor name lists and a boolean flag
name lists and a Boolean flag to indicate when et al. should be appended to the name list.
to indicate when et al. should be appended to the name list.


When the value assigned to |display-xxxxors= is a number greater than or equal to zero,
When the value assigned to |display-xxxxors= is a number greater than or equal to zero, return the number and
return the number and the previous state of the 'etal' flag (false by default
the previous state of the 'etal' flag (false by default but may have been set to true if the name list contains
but may have been set to true if the name list contains some variant of the text 'et al.').
some variant of the text 'et al.').


When the value assigned to |display-xxxxors= is the keyword 'etal', return a number
When the value assigned to |display-xxxxors= is the keyword 'etal', return a number that is one greater than the
that is one greater than the number of authors in the list and set the 'etal' flag true.
number of authors in the list and set the 'etal' flag true. This will cause the list_people() to display all of
This will cause the list_people() to display all of the names in the name list followed by 'et al.'
the names in the name list followed by 'et al.'


In all other cases, returns nil and the previous state of the 'etal' flag.
In all other cases, returns nil and the previous state of the 'etal' flag.


inputs:
inputs:
max: A['DisplayAuthors'] or A['DisplayEditors'], etc; a number or some flavor of etal
max: A['DisplayAuthors'] or A['DisplayEditors']; a number or some flavor of etal
count: #a or #e
count: #a or #e
list_name: 'authors' or 'editors'
list_name: 'authors' or 'editors'
etal: author_etal or editor_etal
etal: author_etal or editor_etal
This function sets an error message when |display-xxxxors= value greater than or equal to number of names but
not when <max> comes from {{cs1 config}} global settings.  When using global settings, <param> is set to the
keyword 'cs1 config' which is used to supress the normal error.  Error is suppressed because it is to be expected
that some citations in an article will have the same or fewer names that the limit specified in {{cs1 config}}.


]]
]]


local function get_display_names (max, count, list_name, etal, param)
local function get_display_authors_editors (max, count, list_name, etal)
if utilities.is_set (max) then
if is_set (max) then
if 'etal' == max:lower():gsub("[ '%.]", '') then -- the :gsub() portion makes 'etal' from a variety of 'et al.' spellings and stylings
if 'etal' == max:lower():gsub("[ '%.]", '') then -- the :gsub() portion makes 'etal' from a variety of 'et al.' spellings and stylings
max = count + 1; -- number of authors + 1 so display all author name plus et al.
max = count + 1; -- number of authors + 1 so display all author name plus et al.
Baris 1.908: Baris 1.651:
elseif max:match ('^%d+$') then -- if is a string of numbers
elseif max:match ('^%d+$') then -- if is a string of numbers
max = tonumber (max); -- make it a number
max = tonumber (max); -- make it a number
if (max >= count) and ('cs1 config' ~= param) then -- error when local |display-xxxxors= value greater than or equal to number of names; not an error when using global setting
if max >= count then -- if |display-xxxxors= value greater than or equal to number of authors/editors
utilities.set_message ('err_disp_name', {param, max}); -- add error message
add_maint_cat ('disp_auth_ed', cfg.special_case_translation [list_name]);
max = nil;
end
end
else -- not a valid keyword or number
else -- not a valid keyword or number
utilities.set_message ('err_disp_name', {param, max}); -- add error message
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'invalid_param_val', {'display-' .. list_name, max}, true ) } ); -- add error message
max = nil; -- unset; as if |display-xxxxors= had not been set
max = nil; -- unset; as if |display-xxxxors= had not been set
end
end
Baris 1.922: Baris 1.664:




--[[----------< E X T R A _ T E X T _ I N _ P A G E _ C H E C K >---------------
--[[--------------------------< E X T R A _ T E X T _ I N _ P A G E _ C H E C K >------------------------------


Adds error if |page=, |pages=, |quote-page=, |quote-pages= has what appears to be
Adds page to Category:CS1 maint: extra text if |page= or |pages= has what appears to be some form of p. or pp.  
some form of p. or pp. abbreviation in the first characters of the parameter content.
abbreviation in the first characters of the parameter content.


check page for extraneous p, p., pp, pp., pg, pg. at start of parameter value:
check Page and Pages for extraneous p, p., pp, and pp. at start of parameter value:
good pattern: '^P[^%.P%l]' matches when page begins PX or P# but not Px
good pattern: '^P[^%.P%l]' matches when |page(s)= begins PX or P# but not Px where x and X are letters and # is a dgiit
      where x and X are letters and # is a digit
bad pattern: '^[Pp][Pp]' matches matches when |page(s)= begins pp or pP or Pp or PP
bad pattern: '^[Pp][PpGg]' matches when page begins pp, pP, Pp, PP, pg, pG, Pg, PG


]]
]]


local function extra_text_in_page_check (val, name)
local function extra_text_in_page_check (page)
if not val:match (cfg.vol_iss_pg_patterns.good_ppattern) then
local good_pattern = '^P[^%.Pp]'; -- ok to begin with uppercase P: P7 (pg 7 of section P) but not p123 (page 123) TODO: add Gg for PG or Pg?
for _, pattern in ipairs (cfg.vol_iss_pg_patterns.bad_ppatterns) do -- spin through the selected sequence table of patterns
local bad_pattern = '^[Pp]?[Pp]%.?[ %d]';
if val:match (pattern) then -- when a match, error so
 
utilities.set_message ('err_extra_text_pages', name); -- add error message
if not page:match (good_pattern) and (page:match (bad_pattern) or  page:match ('^[Pp]ages?')) then
return; -- and done
add_maint_cat ('extra_text');
end
end
end
end
end
end




--[[--------------------------< E X T R A _ T E X T _ I N _ V O L _ I S S _ C H E C K >------------------------
--[=[-------------------------< G E T _ V _ N A M E _ T A B L E >----------------------------------------------


Adds error if |volume= or |issue= has what appears to be some form of redundant 'type' indicator.
split apart a |vauthors= or |veditors= parameter.  This function allows for corporate names, wrapped in doubled
 
parentheses to also have commas; in the old version of the code, the doubled parnetheses were included in the
For |volume=:
rendered citation and in the metadata.  Individual author names may be wikilinked
'V.', or 'Vol.' (with or without the dot) abbreviations or 'Volume' in the first characters of the parameter
content (all case insensitive). 'V' and 'v' (without the dot) are presumed to be roman numerals so
are allowed.
 
For |issue=:
'No.', 'I.', 'Iss.' (with or without the dot) abbreviations, or 'Issue' in the first characters of the
parameter content (all case insensitive).
Single character values ('v', 'i', 'n') allowed when not followed by separator character ('.', ':', '=', or
whitespace character) – param values are trimmed of whitespace by MediaWiki before delivered to the module.
<val> is |volume= or |issue= parameter value
<name> is |volume= or |issue= parameter name for error message
<selector> is 'v' for |volume=, 'i' for |issue=
 
sets error message on failure; returns nothing
 
]]
 
local function extra_text_in_vol_iss_check (val, name, selector)
if not utilities.is_set (val) then
return;
end
local patterns = 'v' == selector and cfg.vol_iss_pg_patterns.vpatterns or cfg.vol_iss_pg_patterns.ipatterns;
 
local handler = 'v' == selector and 'err_extra_text_volume' or 'err_extra_text_issue';
val = val:lower(); -- force parameter value to lower case
for _, pattern in ipairs (patterns) do -- spin through the selected sequence table of patterns
if val:match (pattern) then -- when a match, error so
utilities.set_message (handler, name); -- add error message
return; -- and done
end
end
end
 
 
--[=[-------------------------< G E T _ V _ N A M E _ T A B L E >----------------------------------------------
 
split apart a |vauthors= or |veditors= parameter.  This function allows for corporate names, wrapped in doubled
parentheses to also have commas; in the old version of the code, the doubled parentheses were included in the
rendered citation and in the metadata.  Individual author names may be wikilinked


|vauthors=Jones AB, [[E. B. White|White EB]], ((Black, Brown, and Co.))
|vauthors=Jones AB, [[E. B. White|White EB]], ((Black, Brown, and Co.))
Baris 2.000: Baris 1.697:
local function get_v_name_table (vparam, output_table, output_link_table)
local function get_v_name_table (vparam, output_table, output_link_table)
local name_table = mw.text.split(vparam, "%s*,%s*"); -- names are separated by commas
local name_table = mw.text.split(vparam, "%s*,%s*"); -- names are separated by commas
local wl_type, label, link; -- wl_type not used here; just a placeholder
local wl_type, label, link; -- wl_type not used here; just a place holder
local i = 1;
local i = 1;
while name_table[i] do
while name_table[i] do
if name_table[i]:match ('^%(%(.*[^%)][^%)]$') then -- first segment of corporate with one or more commas; this segment has the opening doubled parentheses
if name_table[i]:match ('^%(%(.*[^%)][^%)]$') then -- first segment of corporate with one or more commas; this segment has the opening doubled parens
local name = name_table[i];
local name = name_table[i];
i = i + 1; -- bump indexer to next segment
i=i+1; -- bump indexer to next segment
while name_table[i] do
while name_table[i] do
name = name .. ', ' .. name_table[i]; -- concatenate with previous segments
name = name .. ', ' .. name_table[i]; -- concatenate with previous segments
if name_table[i]:match ('^.*%)%)$') then -- if this table member has the closing doubled parentheses
if name_table[i]:match ('^.*%)%)$') then -- if this table member has the closing doubled parens
break; -- and done reassembling so
break; -- and done reassembling so
end
end
i = i + 1; -- bump indexer
i=i+1; -- bump indexer
end
end
table.insert (output_table, name); -- and add corporate name to the output table
table.insert (output_table, name); -- and add corporate name to the output table
table.insert (output_link_table, ''); -- no wikilink
table.insert (output_link_table, ''); -- no wikilink
else
else
wl_type, label, link = utilities.is_wikilink (name_table[i]); -- wl_type is: 0, no wl (text in label variable); 1, [[D]]; 2, [[L|D]]
wl_type, label, link = is_wikilink (name_table[i]); -- wl_type is: 0, no wl (text in label variable); 1, [[D]]; 2, [[L|D]]
table.insert (output_table, label); -- add this name
table.insert (output_table, label); -- add this name
if 1 == wl_type then
if 1 == wl_type then
Baris 2.026: Baris 1.723:
end
end
end
end
i = i + 1;
i = i+1;
end
end
return output_table;
return output_table;
Baris 2.039: Baris 1.736:
Author / editor names in |vauthors= or |veditors= must be in Vancouver system style. Corporate or institutional names
Author / editor names in |vauthors= or |veditors= must be in Vancouver system style. Corporate or institutional names
may sometimes be required and because such names will often fail the is_good_vanc_name() and other format compliance
may sometimes be required and because such names will often fail the is_good_vanc_name() and other format compliance
tests, are wrapped in doubled parentheses ((corporate name)) to suppress the format tests.
tests, are wrapped in doubled paranethese ((corporate name)) to suppress the format tests.


Supports generational suffixes Jr, 2nd, 3rd, 4th–6th.
Supports generational suffixes Jr, 2nd, 3rd, 4th–6th.


This function sets the Vancouver error when a required comma is missing and when there is a space between an author's initials.
This function sets the vancouver error when a reqired comma is missing and when there is a space between an author's initials.


]]
]]
Baris 2.056: Baris 1.753:


vparam, etal = name_has_etal (vparam, etal, true); -- find and remove variations on et al. do not categorize (do it here because et al. might have a period)
vparam, etal = name_has_etal (vparam, etal, true); -- find and remove variations on et al. do not categorize (do it here because et al. might have a period)
v_name_table = get_v_name_table (vparam, v_name_table, v_link_table); -- names are separated by commas
v_name_table = get_v_name_table (vparam, v_name_table, v_link_table); -- names are separated by commas


for i, v_name in ipairs(v_name_table) do
for i, v_name in ipairs(v_name_table) do
first = ''; -- set to empty string for concatenation and because it may have been set for previous author/editor
if v_name:match ('^%(%(.+%)%)$') then -- corporate authors are wrapped in doubled parentheses to supress vanc formatting and error detection
local accept_name;
first = ''; -- set to empty string for concatenation and because it may have been set for previous author/editor
v_name, accept_name = utilities.has_accept_as_written (v_name); -- remove accept-this-as-written markup when it wraps all of <v_name>
last = v_name:match ('^%(%((.+)%)%)$') -- remove doubled parntheses
 
if accept_name then
last = v_name;
corporate = true; -- flag used in list_people()
corporate = true; -- flag used in list_people()
elseif string.find(v_name, "%s") then
elseif string.find(v_name, "%s") then
if v_name:find('[;%.]') then -- look for commonly occurring punctuation characters;  
if v_name:find('[;%.]') then -- look for commonly occurring punctuation characters;  
add_vanc_error (cfg.err_msg_supl.punctuation, i);
add_vanc_error ('punctuation');
end
end
local lastfirstTable = {}
local lastfirstTable = {}
lastfirstTable = mw.text.split(v_name, "%s+")
lastfirstTable = mw.text.split(v_name, "%s")
first = table.remove(lastfirstTable); -- removes and returns value of last element in table which should be initials or generational suffix
first = table.remove(lastfirstTable); -- removes and returns value of last element in table which should be author intials
 
if is_suffix (first) then -- if a valid suffix
if not mw.ustring.match (first, '^%u+$') then -- mw.ustring here so that later we will catch non-Latin characters
suffix = first -- save it as a suffix and
suffix = first; -- not initials so assume that whatever we got is a generational suffix
first = table.remove(lastfirstTable); -- get what should be the initials from the table
first = table.remove(lastfirstTable); -- get what should be the initials from the table
end
end -- no suffix error message here because letter combination may be result of Romanization; check for digits?
last = table.concat(lastfirstTable, ' ') -- returns a string that is the concatenation of all other names that are not initials and generational suffix
last = table.concat(lastfirstTable, " ") -- returns a string that is the concatenation of all other names that are not initials
if not utilities.is_set (last) then
first = ''; -- unset
last = v_name; -- last empty because something wrong with first
add_vanc_error (cfg.err_msg_supl.name, i);
end
if mw.ustring.match (last, '%a+%s+%u+%s+%a+') then
if mw.ustring.match (last, '%a+%s+%u+%s+%a+') then
add_vanc_error (cfg.err_msg_supl['missing comma'], i); -- matches last II last; the case when a comma is missing
add_vanc_error ('missing comma'); -- matches last II last; the case when a comma is missing
end
end
if mw.ustring.match (v_name, ' %u %u$') then -- this test is in the wrong place TODO: move or replace with a more appropriate test
if mw.ustring.match (v_name, ' %u %u$') then -- this test is in the wrong place TODO: move or replace with a more appropriate test
add_vanc_error (cfg.err_msg_supl.initials, i); -- matches a space between two initials
add_vanc_error ('name'); -- matches a space between two intiials
end
end
else
else
first = ''; -- set to empty string for concatenation and because it may have been set for previous author/editor
last = v_name; -- last name or single corporate name?  Doesn't support multiword corporate names? do we need this?
last = v_name; -- last name or single corporate name?  Doesn't support multiword corporate names? do we need this?
end
end
if utilities.is_set (first) then
if is_set (first) then
if not mw.ustring.match (first, "^%u?%u$") then -- first shall contain one or two upper-case letters, nothing else
if not mw.ustring.match (first, "^%u?%u$") then -- first shall contain one or two upper-case letters, nothing else
add_vanc_error (cfg.err_msg_supl.initials, i); -- too many initials; mixed case initials (which may be ok Romanization); hyphenated initials
add_vanc_error ('initials'); -- too many initials; mixed case initials (which may be ok Romanization); hyphenated initials
end
end
is_good_vanc_name (last, first, suffix, i); -- check first and last before restoring the suffix which may have a non-Latin digit
is_good_vanc_name (last, first); -- check first and last before restoring the suffix which may have a non-Latin digit
if utilities.is_set (suffix) then
if is_set (suffix) then
first = first .. ' ' .. suffix; -- if there was a suffix concatenate with the initials
first = first .. ' ' .. suffix; -- if there was a suffix concatenate with the initials
suffix = ''; -- unset so we don't add this suffix to all subsequent names
suffix = ''; -- unset so we don't add this suffix to all subsequent names
Baris 2.105: Baris 1.794:
else
else
if not corporate then
if not corporate then
is_good_vanc_name (last, '', nil, i);
is_good_vanc_name (last, '');
end
end
end
end


link = utilities.select_one ( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Link'], 'err_redundant_parameters', i ) or v_link_table[i];
link = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Link'], 'redundant_parameters', i ) or v_link_table[i];
mask = utilities.select_one ( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Mask'], 'err_redundant_parameters', i );
mask = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Mask'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
names[i] = {last = last, first = first, link = link, mask = mask, corporate = corporate}; -- add this assembled name to our names list
names[i] = {last = last, first = first, link = link, mask = mask, corporate=corporate}; -- add this assembled name to our names list
end
end
return names, etal; -- all done, return our list of names
return names, etal; -- all done, return our list of names
Baris 2.120: Baris 1.809:


Select one of |authors=, |authorn= / |lastn / firstn=, or |vauthors= as the source of the author name list or
Select one of |authors=, |authorn= / |lastn / firstn=, or |vauthors= as the source of the author name list or
select one of |editorn= / editor-lastn= / |editor-firstn= or |veditors= as the source of the editor name list.
select one of |editors=, |editorn= / editor-lastn= / |editor-firstn= or |veditors= as the source of the editor name list.


Only one of these appropriate three will be used.  The hierarchy is: |authorn= (and aliases) highest and |authors= lowest;
Only one of these appropriate three will be used.  The hierarchy is: |authorn= (and aliases) highest and |authors= lowest and
|editorn= (and aliases) highest and |veditors= lowest (support for |editors= withdrawn)
similarly, |editorn= (and aliases) highest and |editors= lowest


When looking for |authorn= / |editorn= parameters, test |xxxxor1= and |xxxxor2= (and all of their aliases); stops after the second
When looking for |authorn= / |editorn= parameters, test |xxxxor1= and |xxxxor2= (and all of their aliases); stops after the second
Baris 2.131: Baris 1.820:
Emits an error message when more than one xxxxor name source is provided.
Emits an error message when more than one xxxxor name source is provided.


In this function, vxxxxors = vauthors or veditors; xxxxors = authors as appropriate.
In this function, vxxxxors = vauthors or veditors; xxxxors = authors or editors as appropriate.


]]
]]


local function select_author_editor_source (vxxxxors, xxxxors, args, list_name)
local function select_author_editor_source (vxxxxors, xxxxors, args, list_name)
local lastfirst = false;
local lastfirst = false;
if utilities.select_one ( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Last'], 'none', 1 ) or -- do this twice in case we have a |first1= without a |last1=; this ...
if select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Last'], 'none', 1 ) or -- do this twice incase we have a |first1= without a |last1=; this ...
utilities.select_one ( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-First'], 'none', 1 ) or -- ... also catches the case where |first= is used with |vauthors=
select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-First'], 'none', 1 ) or -- ... also catches the case where |first= is used with |vauthors=
utilities.select_one ( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Last'], 'none', 2 ) or
select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Last'], 'none', 2 ) or
utilities.select_one ( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-First'], 'none', 2 ) then
select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-First'], 'none', 2 ) then
lastfirst = true;
lastfirst=true;
end
end


if (utilities.is_set (vxxxxors) and true == lastfirst) or -- these are the three error conditions
if (is_set (vxxxxors) and true == lastfirst) or -- these are the three error conditions
(utilities.is_set (vxxxxors) and utilities.is_set (xxxxors)) or
(is_set (vxxxxors) and is_set (xxxxors)) or
(true == lastfirst and utilities.is_set (xxxxors)) then
(true == lastfirst and is_set (xxxxors)) then
local err_name;
local err_name;
if 'AuthorList' == list_name then -- figure out which name should be used in error message
if 'AuthorList' == list_name then -- figure out which name should be used in error message
Baris 2.153: Baris 1.842:
err_name = 'editor';
err_name = 'editor';
end
end
utilities.set_message ('err_redundant_parameters', err_name .. '-name-list parameters'); -- add error message
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters',
{err_name .. '-name-list parameters'}, true ) } ); -- add error message
end
end


if true == lastfirst then return 1 end; -- return a number indicating which author name source to use
if true == lastfirst then return 1 end; -- return a number indicating which author name source to use
if utilities.is_set (vxxxxors) then return 2 end;
if is_set (vxxxxors) then return 2 end;
if utilities.is_set (xxxxors) then return 3 end;
if is_set (xxxxors) then return 3 end;
return 1; -- no authors so return 1; this allows missing author name test to run in case there is a first without last  
return 1; -- no authors so return 1; this allows missing author name test to run in case there is a first without last  
end
end
Baris 2.166: Baris 1.856:


This function is used to validate a parameter's assigned value for those parameters that have only a limited number
This function is used to validate a parameter's assigned value for those parameters that have only a limited number
of allowable values (yes, y, true, live, dead, etc.).  When the parameter value has not been assigned a value (missing
of allowable values (yes, y, true, no, etc).  When the parameter value has not been assigned a value (missing or empty
or empty in the source template) the function returns the value specified by ret_val.  If the parameter value is one
in the source template) the function returns true.  If the parameter value is one of the list of allowed values returns
of the list of allowed values returns the translated value; else, emits an error message and returns the value
true; else, emits an error message and returns false.
specified by ret_val.
 
TODO: explain <invert>


]]
]]


local function is_valid_parameter_value (value, name, possible, ret_val, invert)
local function is_valid_parameter_value (value, name, possible)
if not utilities.is_set (value) then
if not is_set (value) then
return ret_val; -- an empty parameter is ok
return true; -- an empty parameter is ok
end
elseif in_array(value:lower(), possible) then
 
return true;
if (not invert and utilities.in_array (value, possible)) then -- normal; <value> is in <possible> table
return cfg.keywords_xlate[value]; -- return translation of parameter keyword
elseif invert and not utilities.in_array (value, possible) then -- invert; <value> is not in <possible> table
return value; -- return <value> as it is
else
else
utilities.set_message ('err_invalid_param_val', {name, value}); -- not an allowed value so add error message
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'invalid_param_val', {name, value}, true ) } ); -- not an allowed value so add error message
return ret_val;
return false
end
end
end
end
Baris 2.201: Baris 1.884:


local function terminate_name_list (name_list, sepc)
local function terminate_name_list (name_list, sepc)
if (string.sub (name_list, -3, -1) == sepc .. '. ') then -- if already properly terminated
if (string.sub (name_list,-3,-1) == sepc .. '. ') then -- if already properly terminated
return name_list; -- just return the name list
return name_list; -- just return the name list
elseif (string.sub (name_list, -1, -1) == sepc) or (string.sub (name_list, -3, -1) == sepc .. ']]') then -- if last name in list ends with sepc char
elseif (string.sub (name_list,-1,-1) == sepc) or (string.sub (name_list,-3,-1) == sepc .. ']]') then -- if last name in list ends with sepc char
return name_list .. " "; -- don't add another
return name_list .. " "; -- don't add another
else
else
return name_list .. sepc .. ' '; -- otherwise terminate the name list
return name_list .. sepc .. ' '; -- otherwise terninate the name list
end
end
end
end




--[[-------------------------< F O R M A T _ V O L U M E _ I S S U E >-----------------------------------------
--[[-------------------------< F O R M A T _ V O L U M E _ I S S U E >----------------------------------------


returns the concatenation of the formatted volume and issue (or journal article number) parameters as a single
returns the concatenation of the formatted volume and issue parameters as a single string; or formatted volume
string; or formatted volume or formatted issue, or an empty string if neither are set.
or formatted issue, or an empty string if neither are set.


]]
]]
local function format_volume_issue (volume, issue, article, cite_class, origin, sepc, lower)
local function format_volume_issue (volume, issue, cite_class, origin, sepc, lower)
if not utilities.is_set (volume) and not utilities.is_set (issue) and not utilities.is_set (article) then
if not is_set (volume) and not is_set (issue) then
return '';
return '';
end
end
-- same condition as in format_pages_sheets()
local is_journal = 'journal' == cite_class or (utilities.in_array (cite_class, {'citation', 'map', 'interview'}) and 'journal' == origin);
local is_numeric_vol = volume and (volume:match ('^[MDCLXVI]+$') or volume:match ('^%d+$')); -- is only uppercase roman numerals or only digits?
local is_long_vol = volume and (4 < mw.ustring.len(volume)); -- is |volume= value longer than 4 characters?
if volume and (not is_numeric_vol and is_long_vol) then -- when not all digits or Roman numerals, is |volume= longer than 4 characters?
if 'magazine' == cite_class or (in_array (cite_class, {'citation', 'map'}) and 'magazine' == origin) then
utilities.add_prop_cat ('long-vol'); -- yes, add properties cat
if is_set (volume) and is_set (issue) then
return wrap_msg ('vol-no', {sepc, volume, issue}, lower);
elseif is_set (volume) then
return wrap_msg ('vol', {sepc, volume}, lower);
else
return wrap_msg ('issue', {sepc, issue}, lower);
end
end
end


if is_journal then -- journal-style formatting
local vol = '';
local vol = '';
 
if is_set (volume) then
if utilities.is_set (volume) then
if (4 < mw.ustring.len(volume)) then
if is_numeric_vol then -- |volume= value all digits or all uppercase Roman numerals?
vol = substitute (cfg.messages['j-vol'], {sepc, volume});
vol = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['vol-bold'], {sepc, volume}); -- render in bold face
else
elseif is_long_vol then -- not all digits or Roman numerals; longer than 4 characters?
vol = substitute (cfg.presentation['vol-bold'], {sepc, hyphen_to_dash(volume)});
vol = utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['j-vol'], {sepc, utilities.hyphen_to_dash (volume)}); -- not bold
else -- four or fewer characters
vol = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['vol-bold'], {sepc, utilities.hyphen_to_dash (volume)}); -- bold
end
end
vol = vol .. (utilities.is_set (issue) and utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['j-issue'], issue) or '')
vol = vol .. (utilities.is_set (article) and utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['j-article-num'], article) or '')
return vol;
end
if 'podcast' == cite_class and utilities.is_set (issue) then
return wrap_msg ('issue', {sepc, issue}, lower);
end
if 'conference' == cite_class and utilities.is_set (article) then -- |article-number= supported only in journal and conference cites
if utilities.is_set (volume) and utilities.is_set (article) then -- both volume and article number
return wrap_msg ('vol-art', {sepc, utilities.hyphen_to_dash (volume), article}, lower);
elseif utilities.is_set (article) then -- article number alone; when volume alone, handled below
return wrap_msg ('art', {sepc, article}, lower);
end
end
end
end
 
if is_set (issue) then
-- all other types of citation
return vol .. substitute (cfg.messages['j-issue'], issue);
if utilities.is_set (volume) and utilities.is_set (issue) then
return wrap_msg ('vol-no', {sepc, utilities.hyphen_to_dash (volume), issue}, lower);
elseif utilities.is_set (volume) then
return wrap_msg ('vol', {sepc, utilities.hyphen_to_dash (volume)}, lower);
else
return wrap_msg ('issue', {sepc, issue}, lower);
end
end
return vol;
end
end


Baris 2.285: Baris 1.944:
local function format_pages_sheets (page, pages, sheet, sheets, cite_class, origin, sepc, nopp, lower)
local function format_pages_sheets (page, pages, sheet, sheets, cite_class, origin, sepc, nopp, lower)
if 'map' == cite_class then -- only cite map supports sheet(s) as in-source locators
if 'map' == cite_class then -- only cite map supports sheet(s) as in-source locators
if utilities.is_set (sheet) then
if is_set (sheet) then
if 'journal' == origin then
if 'journal' == origin then
return '', '', wrap_msg ('j-sheet', sheet, lower), '';
return '', '', wrap_msg ('j-sheet', sheet, lower), '';
Baris 2.291: Baris 1.950:
return '', '', wrap_msg ('sheet', {sepc, sheet}, lower), '';
return '', '', wrap_msg ('sheet', {sepc, sheet}, lower), '';
end
end
elseif utilities.is_set (sheets) then
elseif is_set (sheets) then
if 'journal' == origin then
if 'journal' == origin then
return '', '', '', wrap_msg ('j-sheets', sheets, lower);
return '', '', '', wrap_msg ('j-sheets', sheets, lower);
Baris 2.300: Baris 1.959:
end
end


local is_journal = 'journal' == cite_class or (utilities.in_array (cite_class, {'citation', 'map', 'interview'}) and 'journal' == origin);
local is_journal = 'journal' == cite_class or (in_array (cite_class, {'citation', 'map', 'interview'}) and 'journal' == origin);
if utilities.is_set (page) then
if is_set (page) then
if is_journal then
if is_journal then
return utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['j-page(s)'], page), '', '', '';
return substitute (cfg.messages['j-page(s)'], page), '', '', '';
elseif not nopp then
elseif not nopp then
return utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['p-prefix'], {sepc, page}), '', '', '';
return substitute (cfg.messages['p-prefix'], {sepc, page}), '', '', '';
else
else
return utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['nopp'], {sepc, page}), '', '', '';
return substitute (cfg.messages['nopp'], {sepc, page}), '', '', '';
end
end
elseif utilities.is_set (pages) then
elseif is_set(pages) then
if is_journal then
if is_journal then
return utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['j-page(s)'], pages), '', '', '';
return substitute (cfg.messages['j-page(s)'], pages), '', '', '';
elseif tonumber(pages) ~= nil and not nopp then -- if pages is only digits, assume a single page number
elseif tonumber(pages) ~= nil and not nopp then -- if pages is only digits, assume a single page number
return '', utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['p-prefix'], {sepc, pages}), '', '';
return '', substitute (cfg.messages['p-prefix'], {sepc, pages}), '', '';
elseif not nopp then
elseif not nopp then
return '', utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['pp-prefix'], {sepc, pages}), '', '';
return '', substitute (cfg.messages['pp-prefix'], {sepc, pages}), '', '';
else
else
return '', utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['nopp'], {sepc, pages}), '', '';
return '', substitute (cfg.messages['nopp'], {sepc, pages}), '', '';
end
end
end
end
Baris 2.326: Baris 1.985:




--[[--------------------------< I N S O U R C E _ L O C _ G E T >----------------------------------------------
--[=[-------------------------< A R C H I V E _ U R L _ C H E C K >--------------------------------------------


returns one of the in-source locators: page, pages, or at.  
Check archive.org urls to make sure they at least look like they are pointing at valid archives and not to the
save snapshot url or to calendar pages.  When the archive url is 'https://web.archive.org/save/' (or http://...)
archive.org saves a snapshot of the target page in the url.  That is something that Wikipedia should not allow
unwitting readers to do.


If any of these are interwiki links to Wikisource, returns the label portion of the interwiki-link as plain text
When the archive.org url does not have a complete timestamp, archive.org chooses a snapshot according to its own
for use in COinS. This COinS thing is done because here we convert an interwiki-link to an external link and
algorithm or provides a calendar 'search' result[[WP:ELNO]] discourages links to search results.
add an icon span around that; get_coins_pages() doesn't know about the spanTODO: should it? 


TODO: add support for sheet and sheets?; streamline;
This function looks at the value assigned to |archive-url= and returns empty strings for |archive-url= and
|archive-date= and an error message when:
|archive-url= holds an archive.org save command url
|archive-url= is an archive.org url that does not have a complete timestamp (YYYYMMDDhhmmss 14 digits) in the
correct place
otherwise returns |archive-url= and |archive-date=


TODO: make it so that this function returns only one of the three as the single in-source (the return value assigned
There are two mostly compatible archive.org urls:
to a new name)?
//web.archive.org/<timestamp>... -- the old form
//web.archive.org/web/<timestamp>... -- the new form


]]
The old form does not support or map to the new form when it contains a display flag.  There are four identified flags
('id_', 'js_', 'cs_', 'im_') but since archive.org ignores others following the same form (two letters and an underscore)
we don't check for these specific flags but we do check the form.


local function insource_loc_get (page, page_orig, pages, pages_orig, at)
This function supports a preview mode.  When the article is rendered in preview mode, this funct may return a modified
local ws_url, ws_label, coins_pages, L; -- for Wikisource interwiki-links; TODO: this corrupts page metadata (span remains in place after cleanup; fix there?)
archive url:
for save command errors, return undated wildcard (/*/)
for timestamp errors when the timestamp has a wildcard, return the url unmodified
for timestamp errors when the timestamp does not have a wildcard, return with timestamp limited to six digits plus wildcard (/yyyymm*/)


if utilities.is_set (page) then
]=]
if utilities.is_set (pages) or utilities.is_set (at) then
pages = ''; -- unset the others
at = '';
end
extra_text_in_page_check (page, page_orig); -- emit error message when |page= value begins with what looks like p., pp., etc.


ws_url, ws_label, L = wikisource_url_make (page); -- make ws URL from |page= interwiki link; link portion L becomes tooltip label
local function archive_url_check (url, date)
if ws_url then
local err_msg = ''; -- start with the error message empty
page = external_link (ws_url, ws_label .. '&nbsp;', 'ws link in page'); -- space char after label to move icon away from in-source text; TODO: a better way to do this?
local path, timestamp, flag; -- portions of the archive.or url
page = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['interwiki-icon'], {cfg.presentation['class-wikisource'], L, page});
coins_pages = ws_label;
if (not url:match('//web%.archive%.org/')) and (not url:match('//liveweb%.archive%.org/')) then -- also deprecated liveweb Wayback machine url
end
return url, date; -- not an archive.org archive, return ArchiveURL and ArchiveDate
elseif utilities.is_set (pages) then
end
if utilities.is_set (at) then
at = ''; -- unset
end
extra_text_in_page_check (pages, pages_orig); -- emit error message when |page= value begins with what looks like p., pp., etc.


ws_url, ws_label, L = wikisource_url_make (pages); -- make ws URL from |pages= interwiki link; link portion L becomes tooltip label
if url:match('//web%.archive%.org/save/') then -- if a save command url, we don't want to allow saving of the target page
if ws_url then
err_msg = 'save command';
pages = external_link (ws_url, ws_label .. '&nbsp;', 'ws link in pages'); -- space char after label to move icon away from in-source text; TODO: a better way to do this?
url = url:gsub ('(//web%.archive%.org)/save/', '%1/*/', 1); -- for preview mode: modify ArchiveURL
pages = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['interwiki-icon'], {cfg.presentation['class-wikisource'], L, pages});
elseif url:match('//liveweb%.archive%.org/') then
coins_pages = ws_label;
err_msg = 'liveweb';
end
else
elseif utilities.is_set (at) then
path, timestamp, flag = url:match('//web%.archive%.org/([^%d]*)(%d+)([^/]*)/'); -- split out some of the url parts for evaluation
ws_url, ws_label, L = wikisource_url_make (at); -- make ws URL from |at= interwiki link; link portion L becomes tooltip label
if ws_url then
if not is_set(timestamp) or 14 ~= timestamp:len() then -- path and flag optional, must have 14-digit timestamp here
at = external_link (ws_url, ws_label .. '&nbsp;', 'ws link in at'); -- space char after label to move icon away from in-source text; TODO: a better way to do this?
err_msg = 'timestamp';
at = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['interwiki-icon'], {cfg.presentation['class-wikisource'], L, at});
if '*' ~= flag then
coins_pages = ws_label;
url=url:gsub ('(//web%.archive%.org/[^%d]*%d?%d?%d?%d?%d?%d?)[^/]*', '%1*', 1) -- for preview, modify ts to be yearmo* max (0-6 digits plus splat)
end
elseif is_set(path) and 'web/' ~= path then -- older archive urls do not have the extra 'web/' path element
err_msg = 'path';
elseif is_set (flag) and not is_set (path) then -- flag not allowed with the old form url (without the 'web/' path element)
err_msg = 'flag';
elseif is_set (flag) and not flag:match ('%a%a_') then -- flag if present must be two alpha characters and underscore (requires 'web/' path element)
err_msg = 'flag';
else
return url, date; -- return archiveURL and ArchiveDate
end
end
end
end
-- if here, something not right so
return page, pages, at, coins_pages;
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'archive_url', {err_msg}, true ) } ); -- add error message and
if is_set (Frame:preprocess('{{REVISIONID}}')) then
return '', ''; -- return empty strings for archiveURL and ArchiveDate
else
return url, date; -- preview mode so return archiveURL and ArchiveDate
end
end
end


--[[--------------------------< I S _ U N I Q U E _ A R C H I V E _ U R L >------------------------------------


add error message when |archive-url= value is same as |url= or chapter-url= (or alias...) value
--[[--------------------------< M I S S I N G _ P I P E _ C H E C K >------------------------------------------
 
Look at the contents of a parameter. If the content has a string of characters and digits followed by an equal
sign, compare the alphanumeric string to the list of cs1|2 parameters.  If found, then the string is possibly a
parameter that is missing its pipe:
{{cite ... |title=Title access-date=2016-03-17}}
 
cs1|2 shares some parameter names with xml/html atributes: class=, title=, etc. To prevent false positives xml/html
tags are removed before the search.
 
If a missing pipe is detected, this function adds the missing pipe maintenance category.


]]
]]


local function is_unique_archive_url (archive, url, c_url, source, date)
local function missing_pipe_check (value)
if utilities.is_set (archive) then
local capture;
if archive == url or archive == c_url then
value = value:gsub ('%b<>', ''); -- remove xml/html tags because attributes: class=, title=, etc
utilities.set_message ('err_bad_url', {utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', source)}); -- add error message
 
return '', ''; -- unset |archive-url= and |archive-date= because same as |url= or |chapter-url=
capture = value:match ('%s+(%a[%a%d]+)%s*=') or value:match ('^(%a[%a%d]+)%s*='); -- find and categorize parameters with possible missing pipes
end
if capture and validate (capture) then -- if the capture is a valid parameter name
add_maint_cat ('missing_pipe');
end
end
return archive, date;
end
end




--[=[-------------------------< A R C H I V E _ U R L _ C H E C K >--------------------------------------------
--[[--------------------------< C I T A T I O N 0 >------------------------------------------------------------


Check archive.org URLs to make sure they at least look like they are pointing at valid archives and not to the  
This is the main function doing the majority of the citation formatting.
save snapshot URL or to calendar pages.  When the archive URL is 'https://web.archive.org/save/' (or http://...)
archive.org saves a snapshot of the target page in the URL.  That is something that Wikipedia should not allow
unwitting readers to do.


When the archive.org URL does not have a complete timestamp, archive.org chooses a snapshot according to its own
]]
algorithm or provides a calendar 'search' result.  [[WP:ELNO]] discourages links to search results.


This function looks at the value assigned to |archive-url= and returns empty strings for |archive-url= and
local function citation0( config, args)
|archive-date= and an error message when:
--[[
|archive-url= holds an archive.org save command URL
Load Input Parameters
|archive-url= is an archive.org URL that does not have a complete timestamp (YYYYMMDDhhmmss 14 digits) in the
The argument_wrapper facilitates the mapping of multiple aliases to single internal variable.
correct place
]]
otherwise returns |archive-url= and |archive-date=
local A = argument_wrapper( args );
local i


There are two mostly compatible archive.org URLs:
-- Pick out the relevant fields from the arguments.  Different citation templates
//web.archive.org/<timestamp>... -- the old form
-- define different field names for the same underlying things.
//web.archive.org/web/<timestamp>... -- the new form


The old form does not support or map to the new form when it contains a display flag. There are four identified flags
-- set default parameter values defined by |mode= parameter.
('id_', 'js_', 'cs_', 'im_') but since archive.org ignores others following the same form (two letters and an underscore)
local Mode = A['Mode'];
we don't check for these specific flags but we do check the form.
if not is_valid_parameter_value (Mode, 'mode', cfg.keywords['mode']) then
Mode = '';
end


This function supports a preview mode.  When the article is rendered in preview mode, this function may return a modified
local author_etal;
archive URL:
local a = {}; -- authors list from |lastn= / |firstn= pairs or |vauthors=
for save command errors, return undated wildcard (/*/)
local Authors;
for timestamp errors when the timestamp has a wildcard, return the URL unmodified
local NameListFormat = A['NameListFormat'];
for timestamp errors when the timestamp does not have a wildcard, return with timestamp limited to six digits plus wildcard (/yyyymm*/)
local Collaboration = A['Collaboration'];


A secondary function is to return an archive-url timestamp from those urls that have them (archive.org and
do -- to limit scope of selected
archive.today).  The timestamp is used by validation.archive_date_check() to see if the value in |archive-date=
local selected = select_author_editor_source (A['Vauthors'], A['Authors'], args, 'AuthorList');
matches the timestamp in the archive url.
if 1 == selected then
 
a, author_etal = extract_names (args, 'AuthorList'); -- fetch author list from |authorn= / |lastn= / |firstn=, |author-linkn=, and |author-maskn=
]=]
elseif 2 == selected then
 
NameListFormat = 'vanc'; -- override whatever |name-list-format= might be
local function archive_url_check (url, date)
a, author_etal = parse_vauthors_veditors (args, args.vauthors, 'AuthorList'); -- fetch author list from |vauthors=, |author-linkn=, and |author-maskn=
local err_msg = ''; -- start with the error message empty
elseif 3 == selected then
local path, timestamp, flag; -- portions of the archive.org URL
Authors = A['Authors']; -- use content of |authors=
if 'authors' == A:ORIGIN('Authors') then -- but add a maint cat if the parameter is |authors=
timestamp = url:match ('//archive.today/(%d%d%d%d%d%d%d%d%d%d%d%d%d%d)/'); -- get timestamp from archive.today urls
add_maint_cat ('authors'); -- because use of this parameter is discouraged; what to do about the aliases is a TODO:
if timestamp then -- if this was an archive.today url ...
return url, date, timestamp; -- return ArchiveURL, ArchiveDate, and timestamp from |archive-url=, and done
end
-- here for archive.org urls
if (not url:match('//web%.archive%.org/')) and (not url:match('//liveweb%.archive%.org/')) then -- also deprecated liveweb Wayback machine URL
return url, date; -- not an archive.org archive, return ArchiveURL and ArchiveDate
end
 
if url:match('//web%.archive%.org/save/') then -- if a save command URL, we don't want to allow saving of the target page
err_msg = cfg.err_msg_supl.save;
url = url:gsub ('(//web%.archive%.org)/save/', '%1/*/', 1); -- for preview mode: modify ArchiveURL
elseif url:match('//liveweb%.archive%.org/') then
err_msg = cfg.err_msg_supl.liveweb;
else
path, timestamp, flag = url:match('//web%.archive%.org/([^%d]*)(%d+)([^/]*)/'); -- split out some of the URL parts for evaluation
if not path then -- malformed in some way; pattern did not match
err_msg = cfg.err_msg_supl.timestamp;
elseif 14 ~= timestamp:len() then -- path and flag optional, must have 14-digit timestamp here
err_msg = cfg.err_msg_supl.timestamp;
if '*' ~= flag then
local replacement = timestamp:match ('^%d%d%d%d%d%d') or timestamp:match ('^%d%d%d%d'); -- get the first 6 (YYYYMM) or first 4 digits (YYYY)
if replacement then -- nil if there aren't at least 4 digits (year)
replacement = replacement .. string.rep ('0', 14 - replacement:len()); -- year or yearmo (4 or 6 digits) zero-fill to make 14-digit timestamp
url=url:gsub ('(//web%.archive%.org/[^%d]*)%d[^/]*', '%1' .. replacement .. '*', 1) -- for preview, modify ts to 14 digits plus splat for calendar display
end
end
end
elseif utilities.is_set (path) and 'web/' ~= path then -- older archive URLs do not have the extra 'web/' path element
end
err_msg = cfg.err_msg_supl.path;
if is_set (Collaboration) then
elseif utilities.is_set (flag) and not utilities.is_set (path) then -- flag not allowed with the old form URL (without the 'web/' path element)
author_etal = true; -- so that |display-authors=etal not required
err_msg = cfg.err_msg_supl.flag;
elseif utilities.is_set (flag) and not flag:match ('%a%a_') then -- flag if present must be two alpha characters and underscore (requires 'web/' path element)
err_msg = cfg.err_msg_supl.flag;
else
return url, date, timestamp; -- return ArchiveURL, ArchiveDate, and timestamp from |archive-url=
end
end
end
end
-- if here, something not right so
utilities.set_message ('err_archive_url', {err_msg}); -- add error message and


if is_preview_mode then
local Others = A['Others'];
return url, date, timestamp; -- preview mode so return ArchiveURL, ArchiveDate, and timestamp from |archive-url=
else
return '', ''; -- return empty strings for ArchiveURL and ArchiveDate
end
end


local editor_etal;
local e = {}; -- editors list from |editor-lastn= / |editor-firstn= pairs or |veditors=
local Editors;


--[[--------------------------< P L A C E _ C H E C K >--------------------------------------------------------
do -- to limit scope of selected
 
local selected = select_author_editor_source (A['Veditors'], A['Editors'], args, 'EditorList');
check |place=, |publication-place=, |location= to see if these params include digits.  This function added because
if 1 == selected then
many editors misuse location to specify the in-source location (|page(s)= and |at= are supposed to do that)
e, editor_etal = extract_names (args, 'EditorList'); -- fetch editor list from |editorn= / |editor-lastn= / |editor-firstn=, |editor-linkn=, and |editor-maskn=
 
elseif 2 == selected then
returns the original parameter value without modification; added maint cat when parameter value contains digits
NameListFormat = 'vanc'; -- override whatever |name-list-format= might be
e, editor_etal = parse_vauthors_veditors (args, args.veditors, 'EditorList'); -- fetch editor list from |veditors=, |editor-linkn=, and |editor-maskn=
elseif 3 == selected then
Editors = A['Editors']; -- use content of |editors=
add_maint_cat ('editors'); -- but add a maint cat because use of this parameter is discouraged
end
end


]]
local t = {}; -- translators list from |translator-lastn= / translator-firstn= pairs
local Translators; -- assembled translators name list
t = extract_names (args, 'TranslatorList'); -- fetch translator list from |translatorn= / |translator-lastn=, -firstn=, -linkn=, -maskn=


local function place_check (param_val)
local interviewers_list = {};
if not utilities.is_set (param_val) then -- parameter empty or omitted
local Interviewers = A['Interviewers']
return param_val; -- return that empty state
if is_set (Interviewers) then -- add a maint cat if the |interviewers= is used
add_maint_cat ('interviewers'); -- because use of this parameter is discouraged
else
interviewers_list = extract_names (args, 'InterviewerList'); -- else, process preferred interviewers parameters
end
end
 
if mw.ustring.find (param_val, '%d') then -- not empty, are there digits in the parameter value
local c = {}; -- contributors list from |contributor-lastn= / contributor-firstn= pairs
utilities.set_message ('maint_location'); -- yep, add maint cat
local Contributors; -- assembled contributors name list
local Contribution = A['Contribution'];
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"book","citation"}) and not is_set(A['Periodical']) then -- |contributor= and |contribution= only supported in book cites
c = extract_names (args, 'ContributorList'); -- fetch contributor list from |contributorn= / |contributor-lastn=, -firstn=, -linkn=, -maskn=
if 0 < #c then
if not is_set (Contribution) then -- |contributor= requires |contribution=
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'contributor_missing_required_param', 'contribution')}); -- add missing contribution error message
c = {}; -- blank the contributors' table; it is used as a flag later
end
if 0 == #a then -- |contributor= requires |author=
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'contributor_missing_required_param', 'author')}); -- add missing author error message
c = {}; -- blank the contributors' table; it is used as a flag later
end
end
else -- if not a book cite
if select_one (args, cfg.aliases['ContributorList-Last'], 'redundant_parameters', 1 ) then -- are there contributor name list parameters?
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'contributor_ignored')}); -- add contributor ignored error message
end
Contribution = nil; -- unset
end
end
return param_val; -- and done
end


if not is_valid_parameter_value (NameListFormat, 'name-list-format', cfg.keywords['name-list-format']) then -- only accepted value for this parameter is 'vanc'
NameListFormat = ''; -- anything else, set to empty string
end


--[[--------------------------< I S _ A R C H I V E D _ C O P Y >----------------------------------------------
local Year = A['Year'];
 
local PublicationDate = A['PublicationDate'];
compares |title= to 'Archived copy' (placeholder added by bots that can't find proper title); if matches, return true; nil else
local OrigYear = A['OrigYear'];
local Date = A['Date'];
local LayDate = A['LayDate'];
------------------------------------------------- Get title data
local Title = A['Title'];
local ScriptTitle = A['ScriptTitle'];
local BookTitle = A['BookTitle'];
local Conference = A['Conference'];
local TransTitle = A['TransTitle'];
local TitleNote = A['TitleNote'];
local TitleLink = A['TitleLink'];
link_title_ok (TitleLink, A:ORIGIN ('TitleLink'), Title, 'title'); -- check for wikimarkup in |title-link= or wikimarkup in |title= when |title-link= is set
 
local Chapter = A['Chapter'];
local ScriptChapter = A['ScriptChapter'];
local ChapterLink -- = A['ChapterLink']; -- deprecated as a parameter but still used internally by cite episode
local TransChapter = A['TransChapter'];
local TitleType = A['TitleType'];
local Degree = A['Degree'];
local Docket = A['Docket'];
local ArchiveFormat = A['ArchiveFormat'];


]]
local ArchiveDate;
local ArchiveURL;


local function is_archived_copy (title)
ArchiveURL, ArchiveDate = archive_url_check (A['ArchiveURL'], A['ArchiveDate'])
title = mw.ustring.lower(title); -- switch title to lower case
if title:find (cfg.special_case_translation.archived_copy.en) then -- if title is 'Archived copy'
local DeadURL = A['DeadURL']
return true;
if not is_valid_parameter_value (DeadURL, 'dead-url', cfg.keywords ['deadurl']) then -- set in config.defaults to 'yes'
elseif cfg.special_case_translation.archived_copy['local'] then
DeadURL = ''; -- anything else, set to empty string
if mw.ustring.find (title, cfg.special_case_translation.archived_copy['local']) then -- mw.ustring() because might not be Latin script
return true;
end
end
end
end


local URL = A['URL']
local URLorigin = A:ORIGIN('URL'); -- get name of parameter that holds URL
local ChapterURL = A['ChapterURL'];
local ChapterURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('ChapterURL'); -- get name of parameter that holds ChapterURL
local ConferenceFormat = A['ConferenceFormat'];
local ConferenceURL = A['ConferenceURL'];
local ConferenceURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('ConferenceURL'); -- get name of parameter that holds ConferenceURL
local Periodical = A['Periodical'];
local Periodical_origin = A:ORIGIN('Periodical'); -- get the name of the periodical parameter


--[[--------------------------< C I T A T I O N 0 >------------------------------------------------------------
local Series = A['Series'];
 
This is the main function doing the majority of the citation formatting.
local Volume;
local Issue;
local Page;
local Pages;
local At;


]]
if in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_using_volume) then
Volume = A['Volume'];
end
-- conference & map books do not support issue
if in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_using_issue) and not (in_array (config.CitationClass, {'conference', 'map'}) and not is_set (Periodical))then
Issue = A['Issue'];
end
local Position = '';
if not in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_not_using_page) then
Page = A['Page'];
Pages = hyphen_to_dash( A['Pages'] );
At = A['At'];
end


local function citation0( config, args )
local Edition = A['Edition'];
--[[  
local PublicationPlace = A['PublicationPlace']
Load Input Parameters
local Place = A['Place'];
The argument_wrapper facilitates the mapping of multiple aliases to single internal variable.
]]
local PublisherName = A['PublisherName'];
local A = argument_wrapper ( args );
local RegistrationRequired = A['RegistrationRequired'];
local i
if not is_valid_parameter_value (RegistrationRequired, 'registration', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
RegistrationRequired=nil;
end


-- Pick out the relevant fields from the arguments. Different citation templates
local SubscriptionRequired = A['SubscriptionRequired'];
-- define different field names for the same underlying things.
if not is_valid_parameter_value (SubscriptionRequired, 'subscription', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
SubscriptionRequired=nil;
end


local author_etal;
local UrlAccess = A['UrlAccess'];
local a = {}; -- authors list from |lastn= / |firstn= pairs or |vauthors=
if not is_valid_parameter_value (UrlAccess, 'url-access', cfg.keywords ['url-access']) then
local Authors;
UrlAccess = nil;
local NameListStyle;
end
if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['NameListStyle'] then -- global setting in {{cs1 config}} overrides local |name-list-style= parameter value; nil when empty or assigned value invalid
if not is_set(URL) and is_set(UrlAccess) then
NameListStyle = is_valid_parameter_value (cfg.global_cs1_config_t['NameListStyle'], 'cs1 config: name-list-style', cfg.keywords_lists['name-list-style'], ''); -- error messaging 'param' here is a hoax
UrlAccess = nil;
else
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'param_access_requires_param', {'url'}, true ) } );
NameListStyle = is_valid_parameter_value (A['NameListStyle'], A:ORIGIN('NameListStyle'), cfg.keywords_lists['name-list-style'], '');
end
end


if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['NameListStyle'] and utilities.is_set (A['NameListStyle']) then -- when template has |name-list-style=<something> which global setting has overridden
if is_set (UrlAccess) and is_set (SubscriptionRequired) then -- while not aliases, these are much the same so if both are set
utilities.set_message ('maint_overridden_setting'); -- set a maint message
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'url-access') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'subscription')}, true ) } ); -- add error message
SubscriptionRequired = nil; -- unset; prefer |access= over |subscription=
end
if is_set (UrlAccess) and is_set (RegistrationRequired) then -- these are not the same but contradictory so if both are set
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'url-access') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'registration')}, true ) } ); -- add error message
RegistrationRequired = nil; -- unset; prefer |access= over |registration=
end
end


local Collaboration = A['Collaboration'];
local ChapterUrlAccess = A['ChapterUrlAccess'];
 
if not is_valid_parameter_value (ChapterUrlAccess, 'chapter-url-access', cfg.keywords ['url-access']) then -- same as url-access
do -- to limit scope of selected
ChapterUrlAccess = nil;
local selected = select_author_editor_source (A['Vauthors'], A['Authors'], args, 'AuthorList');
if 1 == selected then
a, author_etal = extract_names (args, 'AuthorList'); -- fetch author list from |authorn= / |lastn= / |firstn=, |author-linkn=, and |author-maskn=
elseif 2 == selected then
NameListStyle = 'vanc'; -- override whatever |name-list-style= might be
a, author_etal = parse_vauthors_veditors (args, A['Vauthors'], 'AuthorList'); -- fetch author list from |vauthors=, |author-linkn=, and |author-maskn=
elseif 3 == selected then
Authors = A['Authors']; -- use content of |authors=
if 'authors' == A:ORIGIN('Authors') then -- but add a maint cat if the parameter is |authors=
utilities.set_message ('maint_authors'); -- because use of this parameter is discouraged; what to do about the aliases is a TODO:
end
end
end
if utilities.is_set (Collaboration) then
if not is_set(ChapterURL) and is_set(ChapterUrlAccess) then
author_etal = true; -- so that |display-authors=etal not required
ChapterUrlAccess = nil;
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'param_access_requires_param', {'chapter-url'}, true ) } );
end
end
end


local editor_etal;
local Via = A['Via'];
local e = {}; -- editors list from |editor-lastn= / |editor-firstn= pairs or |veditors=
local AccessDate = A['AccessDate'];
local Agency = A['Agency'];


do -- to limit scope of selected
local Language = A['Language'];
local selected = select_author_editor_source (A['Veditors'], nil, args, 'EditorList'); -- support for |editors= withdrawn
local Format = A['Format'];
if 1 == selected then
local ChapterFormat = A['ChapterFormat'];
e, editor_etal = extract_names (args, 'EditorList'); -- fetch editor list from |editorn= / |editor-lastn= / |editor-firstn=, |editor-linkn=, and |editor-maskn=
local DoiBroken = A['DoiBroken'];
elseif 2 == selected then
local ID = A['ID'];
NameListStyle = 'vanc'; -- override whatever |name-list-style= might be
local ASINTLD = A['ASINTLD'];
e, editor_etal = parse_vauthors_veditors (args, args.veditors, 'EditorList'); -- fetch editor list from |veditors=, |editor-linkn=, and |editor-maskn=
local IgnoreISBN = A['IgnoreISBN'];
if not is_valid_parameter_value (IgnoreISBN, 'ignore-isbn-error', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
IgnoreISBN = nil; -- anything else, set to empty string
end
end
end
local Embargo = A['Embargo'];
local Class = A['Class']; -- arxiv class identifier
local Chapter = A['Chapter']; -- done here so that we have access to |contribution= from |chapter= aliases
local Chapter_origin = A:ORIGIN ('Chapter');
local Contribution; -- because contribution is required for contributor(s)
if 'contribution' == Chapter_origin then
Contribution = Chapter; -- get the name of the contribution
end
local c = {}; -- contributors list from |contributor-lastn= / contributor-firstn= pairs
if utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {"book", "citation"}) and not utilities.is_set (A['Periodical']) then -- |contributor= and |contribution= only supported in book cites
c = extract_names (args, 'ContributorList'); -- fetch contributor list from |contributorn= / |contributor-lastn=, -firstn=, -linkn=, -maskn=
if 0 < #c then
if not utilities.is_set (Contribution) then -- |contributor= requires |contribution=
utilities.set_message ('err_contributor_missing_required_param', 'contribution'); -- add missing contribution error message
c = {}; -- blank the contributors' table; it is used as a flag later
end
if 0 == #a then -- |contributor= requires |author=
utilities.set_message ('err_contributor_missing_required_param', 'author'); -- add missing author error message
c = {}; -- blank the contributors' table; it is used as a flag later
end
end
else -- if not a book cite
if utilities.select_one (args, cfg.aliases['ContributorList-Last'], 'err_redundant_parameters', 1 ) then -- are there contributor name list parameters?
utilities.set_message ('err_contributor_ignored'); -- add contributor ignored error message
end
Contribution = nil; -- unset
end
 
local Title = A['Title'];
local TitleLink = A['TitleLink'];


local auto_select = ''; -- default is auto
local ID_list = extract_ids( args );
local accept_link;
local ID_access_levels = extract_id_access_levels( args, ID_list );
TitleLink, accept_link = utilities.has_accept_as_written (TitleLink, true); -- test for accept-this-as-written markup
if (not accept_link) and utilities.in_array (TitleLink, {'none', 'pmc', 'doi'}) then -- check for special keywords
auto_select = TitleLink; -- remember selection for later
TitleLink = ''; -- treat as if |title-link= would have been empty
end


TitleLink = link_title_ok (TitleLink, A:ORIGIN ('TitleLink'), Title, 'title'); -- check for wiki-markup in |title-link= or wiki-markup in |title= when |title-link= is set
local Quote = A['Quote'];


local Section = ''; -- {{cite map}} only; preset to empty string for concatenation if not used
local LayFormat = A['LayFormat'];
if 'map' == config.CitationClass and 'section' == Chapter_origin then
local LayURL = A['LayURL'];
Section = A['Chapter']; -- get |section= from |chapter= alias list; |chapter= and the other aliases not supported in {{cite map}}
local LaySource = A['LaySource'];
Chapter = ''; -- unset for now; will be reset later from |map= if present
local Transcript = A['Transcript'];
end
local TranscriptFormat = A['TranscriptFormat'];
local TranscriptURL = A['TranscriptURL']
local TranscriptURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('TranscriptURL'); -- get name of parameter that holds TranscriptURL


local Periodical = A['Periodical'];
local LastAuthorAmp = A['LastAuthorAmp'];
local Periodical_origin = A:ORIGIN('Periodical');
if not is_valid_parameter_value (LastAuthorAmp, 'last-author-amp', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
local ScriptPeriodical = A['ScriptPeriodical'];
LastAuthorAmp = nil; -- set to empty string
local ScriptPeriodical_origin = A:ORIGIN('ScriptPeriodical');
local TransPeriodical =  A['TransPeriodical'];
local TransPeriodical_origin =  A:ORIGIN ('TransPeriodical');
if (utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {'book', 'encyclopaedia'}) and (utilities.is_set (Periodical) or utilities.is_set (ScriptPeriodical) or utilities.is_set (ScriptPeriodical))) then
local param;
if utilities.is_set (Periodical) then -- get a parameter name from one of these periodical related meta-parameters
Periodical = nil; -- unset because not valid {{cite book}} or {{cite encyclopedia}} parameters
param = Periodical_origin -- get parameter name for error messaging
elseif utilities.is_set (TransPeriodical) then
TransPeriodical = nil; -- unset because not valid {{cite book}} or {{cite encyclopedia}} parameters
param = TransPeriodical_origin; -- get parameter name for error messaging
elseif utilities.is_set (ScriptPeriodical) then
ScriptPeriodical = nil; -- unset because not valid {{cite book}} or {{cite encyclopedia}} parameters
param = ScriptPeriodical_origin; -- get parameter name for error messaging
end
end


if utilities.is_set (param) then -- if we found one
local no_tracking_cats = A['NoTracking'];
utilities.set_message ('err_periodical_ignored', {param}); -- emit an error message
if not is_valid_parameter_value (no_tracking_cats, 'no-tracking', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
no_tracking_cats = nil; -- set to empty string
end
end
end


if utilities.is_set (Periodical) then
--local variables that are not cs1 parameters
local i;
local use_lowercase; -- controls capitalization of certain static text
Periodical, i = utilities.strip_apostrophe_markup (Periodical); -- strip apostrophe markup so that metadata isn't contaminated
local this_page = mw.title.getCurrentTitle(); -- also used for COinS and for language
if i then -- non-zero when markup was stripped so emit an error message
local anchor_year; -- used in the CITEREF identifier
utilities.set_message ('err_apostrophe_markup', {Periodical_origin});
local COinS_date = {}; -- holds date info extracted from |date= for the COinS metadata by Module:Date verification
end
 
local DF = A['DF']; -- date format set in cs1|2 template
if not is_valid_parameter_value (DF, 'df', cfg.keywords['date-format']) then -- validate reformatting keyword
DF = ''; -- not valid, set to empty string
end
end


if 'mailinglist' == config.CitationClass then -- special case for {{cite mailing list}}
local sepc; -- separator between citation elements for CS1 a period, for CS2, a comma
if utilities.is_set (Periodical) and utilities.is_set (A ['MailingList']) then -- both set emit an error TODO: make a function for this and similar?
local PostScript;
utilities.set_message ('err_redundant_parameters', {utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', Periodical_origin) .. cfg.presentation['sep_list_pair'] .. utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', 'mailinglist')});
local Ref;
end
sepc, PostScript, Ref = set_style (Mode:lower(), A['PostScript'], A['Ref'], config.CitationClass);
use_lowercase = ( sepc == ',' ); -- used to control capitalization for certain static text


Periodical = A ['MailingList']; -- error or no, set Periodical to |mailinglist= value because this template is {{cite mailing list}}
--check this page to see if it is in one of the namespaces that cs1 is not supposed to add to the error categories
Periodical_origin = A:ORIGIN('MailingList');
if not is_set (no_tracking_cats) then -- ignore if we are already not going to categorize this page
end
if in_array (this_page.nsText, cfg.uncategorized_namespaces) then
 
no_tracking_cats = "true"; -- set no_tracking_cats
-- web and news not tested for now because of
-- Wikipedia:Administrators%27_noticeboard#Is_there_a_semi-automated_tool_that_could_fix_these_annoying_"Cite_Web"_errors?
if not (utilities.is_set (Periodical) or utilities.is_set (ScriptPeriodical)) then -- 'periodical' templates require periodical parameter
-- local p = {['journal'] = 'journal', ['magazine'] = 'magazine', ['news'] = 'newspaper', ['web'] = 'website'}; -- for error message
local p = {['journal'] = 'journal', ['magazine'] = 'magazine'}; -- for error message
if p[config.CitationClass]  then
utilities.set_message ('err_missing_periodical', {config.CitationClass, p[config.CitationClass]});
end
end
end
for _,v in ipairs (cfg.uncategorized_subpages) do -- cycle through page name patterns
if this_page.text:match (v) then -- test page name against each pattern
local Volume;
no_tracking_cats = "true"; -- set no_tracking_cats
-- local ScriptPeriodical_origin = A:ORIGIN('ScriptPeriodical');
break; -- bail out if one is found
if 'citation' == config.CitationClass then
if utilities.is_set (Periodical) then
if not utilities.in_array (Periodical_origin, cfg.citation_no_volume_t) then -- {{citation}} does not render |volume= when these parameters are used
Volume = A['Volume']; -- but does for all other 'periodicals'
end
elseif utilities.is_set (ScriptPeriodical) then
if 'script-website' ~= ScriptPeriodical_origin then -- {{citation}} does not render volume for |script-website=
Volume = A['Volume']; -- but does for all other 'periodicals'
end
end
else
Volume = A['Volume']; -- and does for non-'periodical' cites
end
elseif utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_using_volume) then -- render |volume= for cs1 according to the configuration settings
Volume = A['Volume'];
end
extra_text_in_vol_iss_check (Volume, A:ORIGIN ('Volume'), 'v');
local Issue;
if 'citation' == config.CitationClass then
if utilities.is_set (Periodical) and utilities.in_array (Periodical_origin, cfg.citation_issue_t) then -- {{citation}} may render |issue= when these parameters are used
Issue = utilities.hyphen_to_dash (A['Issue']);
end
elseif utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_using_issue) then -- conference & map books do not support issue; {{citation}} listed here because included in settings table
if not (utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {'conference', 'map', 'citation'}) and not (utilities.is_set (Periodical) or utilities.is_set (ScriptPeriodical))) then
Issue = utilities.hyphen_to_dash (A['Issue']);
end
end
end
end
local ArticleNumber;


if utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {'journal', 'conference'}) or ('citation' == config.CitationClass and utilities.is_set (Periodical) and 'journal' == Periodical_origin) then
-- check for extra |page=, |pages= or |at= parameters. (also sheet and sheets while we're at it)
ArticleNumber = A['ArticleNumber'];
select_one( args, {'page', 'p', 'pp', 'pages', 'at', 'sheet', 'sheets'}, 'redundant_parameters' ); -- this is a dummy call simply to get the error message and category
end


extra_text_in_vol_iss_check (Issue, A:ORIGIN ('Issue'), 'i');
local NoPP = A['NoPP']
 
if is_set (NoPP) and is_valid_parameter_value (NoPP, 'nopp', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
local Page;
NoPP = true;
local Pages;
else
local At;
NoPP = nil; -- unset, used as a flag later
local QuotePage;
local QuotePages;
if not utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_not_using_page) then -- TODO: rewrite to emit ignored parameter error message?
Page = A['Page'];
Pages = utilities.hyphen_to_dash (A['Pages']);
At = A['At'];
QuotePage = A['QuotePage'];
QuotePages = utilities.hyphen_to_dash (A['QuotePages']);
end
end


local Edition = A['Edition'];
if is_set(Page) then
local PublicationPlace = place_check (A['PublicationPlace'], A:ORIGIN('PublicationPlace'));
if is_set(Pages) or is_set(At) then
local Place = place_check (A['Place'], A:ORIGIN('Place'));
Pages = ''; -- unset the others
At = '';
local PublisherName = A['PublisherName'];
end
local PublisherName_origin = A:ORIGIN('PublisherName');
extra_text_in_page_check (Page); -- add this page to maint cat if |page= value begins with what looks like p. or pp.
if utilities.is_set (PublisherName) and (cfg.keywords_xlate['none'] ~= PublisherName) then
elseif is_set(Pages) then
local i = 0;
if is_set(At) then
PublisherName, i = utilities.strip_apostrophe_markup (PublisherName); -- strip apostrophe markup so that metadata isn't contaminated; publisher is never italicized
At = ''; -- unset
if i and (0 < i) then -- non-zero when markup was stripped so emit an error message
utilities.set_message ('err_apostrophe_markup', {PublisherName_origin});
end
end
extra_text_in_page_check (Pages); -- add this page to maint cat if |pages= value begins with what looks like p. or pp.
end
-- both |publication-place= and |place= (|location=) allowed if different
if not is_set(PublicationPlace) and is_set(Place) then
PublicationPlace = Place; -- promote |place= (|location=) to |publication-place
end
end
if ('document' == config.CitationClass) and not utilities.is_set (PublisherName) then
if PublicationPlace == Place then Place = ''; end -- don't need both if they are the same
utilities.set_message ('err_missing_publisher', {config.CitationClass, 'publisher'});
end
--[[
 
Parameter remapping for cite encyclopedia:
local Newsgroup = A['Newsgroup']; -- TODO: strip apostrophe markup?
When the citation has these parameters:
local Newsgroup_origin = A:ORIGIN('Newsgroup');
|encyclopedia and |title then map |title to |article and |encyclopedia to |title
 
|encyclopedia and |article then map |encyclopedia to |title
if 'newsgroup' == config.CitationClass then
|encyclopedia then map |encyclopedia to |title
if utilities.is_set (PublisherName) and (cfg.keywords_xlate['none'] ~= PublisherName) then -- general use parameter |publisher= not allowed in cite newsgroup
utilities.set_message ('err_parameter_ignored', {PublisherName_origin});
|trans-title maps to |trans-chapter when |title is re-mapped
end
|url maps to |chapterurl when |title is remapped
 
PublisherName = nil; -- ensure that this parameter is unset for the time being; will be used again after COinS
end
 
local URL = A['URL']; -- TODO: better way to do this for URL, ChapterURL, and MapURL?
local UrlAccess = is_valid_parameter_value (A['UrlAccess'], A:ORIGIN('UrlAccess'), cfg.keywords_lists['url-access'], nil);
if not utilities.is_set (URL) and utilities.is_set (UrlAccess) then
All other combinations of |encyclopedia, |title, and |article are not modified
UrlAccess = nil;
utilities.set_message ('err_param_access_requires_param', 'url');
end
local ChapterURL = A['ChapterURL'];
]]
local ChapterUrlAccess = is_valid_parameter_value (A['ChapterUrlAccess'], A:ORIGIN('ChapterUrlAccess'), cfg.keywords_lists['url-access'], nil);
if not utilities.is_set (ChapterURL) and utilities.is_set (ChapterUrlAccess) then
ChapterUrlAccess = nil;
utilities.set_message ('err_param_access_requires_param', {A:ORIGIN('ChapterUrlAccess'):gsub ('%-access', '')});
end


local MapUrlAccess = is_valid_parameter_value (A['MapUrlAccess'], A:ORIGIN('MapUrlAccess'), cfg.keywords_lists['url-access'], nil);
local Encyclopedia = A['Encyclopedia'];
if not utilities.is_set (A['MapURL']) and utilities.is_set (MapUrlAccess) then
MapUrlAccess = nil;
utilities.set_message ('err_param_access_requires_param', {'map-url'});
end


local this_page = mw.title.getCurrentTitle(); -- also used for COinS and for language
if ( config.CitationClass == "encyclopaedia" ) or ( config.CitationClass == "citation" and is_set (Encyclopedia)) then -- test code for citation
local no_tracking_cats = is_valid_parameter_value (A['NoTracking'], A:ORIGIN('NoTracking'), cfg.keywords_lists['yes_true_y'], nil);
if is_set(Periodical) then -- Periodical is set when |encyclopedia is set
if is_set(Title) or is_set (ScriptTitle) then
if not is_set(Chapter) then
Chapter = Title; -- |encyclopedia and |title are set so map |title to |article and |encyclopedia to |title
ScriptChapter = ScriptTitle;
TransChapter = TransTitle;
ChapterURL = URL;
ChapterUrlAccess = UrlAccess;


-- check this page to see if it is in one of the namespaces that cs1 is not supposed to add to the error categories
if not is_set (ChapterURL) and is_set (TitleLink) then
if not utilities.is_set (no_tracking_cats) then -- ignore if we are already not going to categorize this page
Chapter = make_wikilink (TitleLink, Chapter);
if cfg.uncategorized_namespaces[this_page.namespace] then -- is this page's namespace id one of the uncategorized namespace ids?
end
no_tracking_cats = "true"; -- set no_tracking_cats
Title = Periodical;
end
ChapterFormat = Format;
for _, v in ipairs (cfg.uncategorized_subpages) do -- cycle through page name patterns
Periodical = ''; -- redundant so unset
if this_page.text:match (v) then -- test page name against each pattern
TransTitle = '';
no_tracking_cats = "true"; -- set no_tracking_cats
URL = '';
break; -- bail out if one is found
Format = '';
TitleLink = '';
ScriptTitle = '';
end
else -- |title not set
Title = Periodical; -- |encyclopedia set and |article set or not set so map |encyclopedia to |title
Periodical = ''; -- redundant so unset
end
end
end
end
end
end
-- check for extra |page=, |pages= or |at= parameters. (also sheet and sheets while we're at it)
utilities.select_one (args, {'page', 'p', 'pp', 'pages', 'at', 'sheet', 'sheets'}, 'err_redundant_parameters'); -- this is a dummy call simply to get the error message and category


local coins_pages;
-- Special case for cite techreport.
if (config.CitationClass == "techreport") then -- special case for cite techreport
Page, Pages, At, coins_pages = insource_loc_get (Page, A:ORIGIN('Page'), Pages, A:ORIGIN('Pages'), At);
if is_set(A['Number']) then -- cite techreport uses 'number', which other citations alias to 'issue'
if not is_set(ID) then -- can we use ID for the "number"?
ID = A['Number']; -- yes, use it
else -- ID has a value so emit error message
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error('redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'id') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'number')}, true )});
end
end
end


local NoPP = is_valid_parameter_value (A['NoPP'], A:ORIGIN('NoPP'), cfg.keywords_lists['yes_true_y'], nil);
-- special case for cite mailing list
if (config.CitationClass == "mailinglist") then
Periodical = A ['MailingList'];
elseif 'mailinglist' == A:ORIGIN('Periodical') then
Periodical = ''; -- unset because mailing list is only used for cite mailing list
end


if utilities.is_set (PublicationPlace) and utilities.is_set (Place) then -- both |publication-place= and |place= (|location=) allowed if different
-- Account for the oddity that is {{cite conference}}, before generation of COinS data.
utilities.add_prop_cat ('location-test'); -- add property cat to evaluate how often PublicationPlace and Place are used together
if 'conference' == config.CitationClass then
if PublicationPlace == Place then
if is_set(BookTitle) then
Place = ''; -- unset; don't need both if they are the same
Chapter = Title;
-- ChapterLink = TitleLink; -- |chapterlink= is deprecated
ChapterURL = URL;
ChapterUrlAccess = UrlAccess;
ChapterURLorigin = URLorigin;
URLorigin = '';
ChapterFormat = Format;
TransChapter = TransTitle;
Title = BookTitle;
Format = '';
-- TitleLink = '';
TransTitle = '';
URL = '';
end
end
elseif not utilities.is_set (PublicationPlace) and utilities.is_set (Place) then -- when only |place= (|location=) is set ...
elseif 'speech' ~= config.CitationClass then
PublicationPlace = Place; -- promote |place= (|location=) to |publication-place
Conference = ''; -- not cite conference or cite speech so make sure this is empty string
end
end


if PublicationPlace == Place then Place = ''; end -- don't need both if they are the same
-- cite map oddities
 
local Cartography = "";
local URL_origin = A:ORIGIN('URL'); -- get name of parameter that holds URL
local Scale = "";
local ChapterURL_origin = A:ORIGIN('ChapterURL'); -- get name of parameter that holds ChapterURL
local Sheet = A['Sheet'] or '';
local ScriptChapter = A['ScriptChapter'];
local Sheets = A['Sheets'] or '';
local ScriptChapter_origin = A:ORIGIN ('ScriptChapter');
if config.CitationClass == "map" then
local Format = A['Format'];
Chapter = A['Map'];
local ChapterFormat = A['ChapterFormat'];
ChapterURL = A['MapURL'];
local TransChapter = A['TransChapter'];
ChapterUrlAccess = UrlAccess;
local TransChapter_origin = A:ORIGIN ('TransChapter');
TransChapter = A['TransMap'];
local TransTitle = A['TransTitle'];
ChapterURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('MapURL');
local ScriptTitle = A['ScriptTitle'];
ChapterFormat = A['MapFormat'];
--[[
Cartography = A['Cartography'];
Parameter remapping for cite encyclopedia:
if is_set( Cartography ) then
When the citation has these parameters:
Cartography = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('cartography', Cartography, use_lowercase);
|encyclopedia= and |title= then map |title= to |article= and |encyclopedia= to |title= for rendering
end
|encyclopedia= and |article= then map |encyclopedia= to |title= for rendering
Scale = A['Scale'];
 
if is_set( Scale ) then
|trans-title= maps to |trans-chapter= when |title= is re-mapped
Scale = sepc .. " " .. Scale;
|url= maps to |chapter-url= when |title= is remapped
All other combinations of |encyclopedia=, |title=, and |article= are not modified
]]
 
local Encyclopedia = A['Encyclopedia']; -- used as a flag by this module and by ~/COinS
 
if utilities.is_set (Encyclopedia) then -- emit error message when Encyclopedia set but template is other than {{cite encyclopedia}} or {{citation}}
if 'encyclopaedia' ~= config.CitationClass and 'citation' ~= config.CitationClass then
utilities.set_message ('err_parameter_ignored', {A:ORIGIN ('Encyclopedia')});
Encyclopedia = nil; -- unset because not supported by this template
end
end
end
end


if ('encyclopaedia' == config.CitationClass) or ('citation' == config.CitationClass and utilities.is_set (Encyclopedia)) then
-- Account for the oddities that are {{cite episode}} and {{cite serial}}, before generation of COinS data.
if utilities.is_set (Periodical) and utilities.is_set (Encyclopedia) then -- when both parameters set emit an error message; {{citation}} only; Periodical not allowed in {{cite encyclopedia}}
if 'episode' == config.CitationClass or 'serial' == config.CitationClass then
utilities.set_message ('err_periodical_ignored', {Periodical_origin});
local AirDate = A['AirDate'];
end
local SeriesLink = A['SeriesLink'];


if utilities.is_set (Encyclopedia) then
link_title_ok (SeriesLink, A:ORIGIN ('SeriesLink'), Series, 'series'); -- check for wikimarkup in |series-link= or wikimarkup in |series= when |series-link= is set
Periodical = Encyclopedia; -- error or no, set Periodical to Encyclopedia for rendering; {{citation}} could (not legitimately) have both; use Encyclopedia
Periodical_origin = A:ORIGIN ('Encyclopedia');


if utilities.is_set (Title) or utilities.is_set (ScriptTitle) then
local Network = A['Network'];
if not utilities.is_set (Chapter) then
local Station = A['Station'];
Chapter = Title; -- |encyclopedia= and |title= are set so map |title= to |article= and |encyclopedia= to |title= for rendering
local s, n = {}, {};
ScriptChapter = ScriptTitle;
-- do common parameters first
ScriptChapter_origin = A:ORIGIN('ScriptTitle')
if is_set(Network) then table.insert(n, Network); end
TransChapter = TransTitle;
if is_set(Station) then table.insert(n, Station); end
ChapterURL = URL;
ID = table.concat(n, sepc .. ' ');
ChapterURL_origin = URL_origin;
if not is_set (Date) and is_set (AirDate) then -- promote airdate to date
Date = AirDate;
end


ChapterUrlAccess = UrlAccess;
if 'episode' == config.CitationClass then -- handle the oddities that are strictly {{cite episode}}
local Season = A['Season'];
local SeriesNumber = A['SeriesNumber'];


if not utilities.is_set (ChapterURL) and utilities.is_set (TitleLink) then
if is_set (Season) and is_set (SeriesNumber) then -- these are mutually exclusive so if both are set
Chapter = utilities.make_wikilink (TitleLink, Chapter);
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'season') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'seriesno')}, true ) } ); -- add error message
end
SeriesNumber = ''; -- unset; prefer |season= over |seriesno=
Title = Periodical;
ChapterFormat = Format;
Periodical = ''; -- redundant so unset
TransTitle = '';
URL = '';
Format = '';
TitleLink = '';
ScriptTitle = '';
end
elseif utilities.is_set (Chapter) or utilities.is_set (ScriptChapter) then -- |title= not set
Title = Periodical; -- |encyclopedia= set and |article= set so map |encyclopedia= to |title= for rendering
Periodical = ''; -- redundant so unset
end
end
end
-- assemble a table of parts concatenated later into Series
end
if is_set(Season) then table.insert(s, wrap_msg ('season', Season, use_lowercase)); end
if is_set(SeriesNumber) then table.insert(s, wrap_msg ('series', SeriesNumber, use_lowercase)); end
if is_set(Issue) then table.insert(s, wrap_msg ('episode', Issue, use_lowercase)); end
Issue = ''; -- unset because this is not a unique parameter
Chapter = Title; -- promote title parameters to chapter
ScriptChapter = ScriptTitle;
ChapterLink = TitleLink; -- alias episodelink
TransChapter = TransTitle;
ChapterURL = URL;
ChapterUrlAccess = UrlAccess;
ChapterURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('URL');
Title = Series; -- promote series to title
TitleLink = SeriesLink;
Series = table.concat(s, sepc .. ' '); -- this is concatenation of season, seriesno, episode number


-- special case for cite techreport.
if is_set (ChapterLink) and not is_set (ChapterURL) then -- link but not URL
local ID = A['ID'];
Chapter = make_wikilink (ChapterLink, Chapter);
if (config.CitationClass == "techreport") then -- special case for cite techreport
elseif is_set (ChapterLink) and is_set (ChapterURL) then -- if both are set, URL links episode;
if utilities.is_set (A['Number']) then -- cite techreport uses 'number', which other citations alias to 'issue'
Series = make_wikilink (ChapterLink, Series);
if not utilities.is_set (ID) then -- can we use ID for the "number"?
end
ID = A['Number']; -- yes, use it
URL = ''; -- unset
else -- ID has a value so emit error message
TransTitle = '';
utilities.set_message ('err_redundant_parameters', {utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', 'id') .. cfg.presentation['sep_list_pair'] .. utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', 'number')});
ScriptTitle = '';
else -- now oddities that are cite serial
Issue = ''; -- unset because this parameter no longer supported by the citation/core version of cite serial
Chapter = A['Episode']; -- TODO: make |episode= available to cite episode someday?
if is_set (Series) and is_set (SeriesLink) then
Series = make_wikilink (SeriesLink, Series);
end
end
Series = wrap_style ('italic-title', Series); -- series is italicized
end
end
end
end
-- end of {{cite episode}} stuff
-- Account for the oddities that are {{cite arxiv}}, {{cite biorxiv}}, {{cite citeseerx}}, before generation of COinS data.
do
if in_array (config.CitationClass, {'arxiv', 'biorxiv', 'citeseerx'}) then
if not is_set (ID_list[config.CitationClass:upper()]) then -- |arxiv= or |eprint= required for cite arxiv; |biorxiv= & |citeseerx= required for their templates
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( config.CitationClass .. '_missing', {}, true ) } ); -- add error message
end
if 'arxiv' == config.CitationClass then
Periodical = 'arXiv'; -- set to arXiv for COinS; after that, must be set to empty string
end


-- Account for the oddity that is {{cite conference}}, before generation of COinS data.
if 'biorxiv' == config.CitationClass then
local ChapterLink -- = A['ChapterLink']; -- deprecated as a parameter but still used internally by cite episode
Periodical = 'bioRxiv'; -- set to bioRxiv for COinS; after that, must be set to empty string
local Conference = A['Conference'];
end
local BookTitle = A['BookTitle'];
 
local TransTitle_origin = A:ORIGIN ('TransTitle');
if 'citeseerx' == config.CitationClass then
if 'conference' == config.CitationClass then
Periodical = 'CiteSeerX'; -- set to CiteSeerX for COinS; after that, must be set to empty string
if utilities.is_set (BookTitle) then
end
Chapter = Title;
Chapter_origin = 'title';
-- ChapterLink = TitleLink; -- |chapter-link= is deprecated
ChapterURL = URL;
ChapterUrlAccess = UrlAccess;
ChapterURL_origin = URL_origin;
URL_origin = '';
ChapterFormat = Format;
TransChapter = TransTitle;
TransChapter_origin = TransTitle_origin;
Title = BookTitle;
Format = '';
-- TitleLink = '';
TransTitle = '';
URL = '';
end
end
elseif 'speech' ~= config.CitationClass then
Conference = ''; -- not cite conference or cite speech so make sure this is empty string
end
end
 
-- CS1/2 mode
-- handle type parameter for those CS1 citations that have default values
local Mode;
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"AV-media-notes", "interview", "mailinglist", "map", "podcast", "pressrelease", "report", "techreport", "thesis"}) then
if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['Mode'] then -- global setting in {{cs1 config}} overrides local |mode= parameter value; nil when empty or assigned value invalid
TitleType = set_titletype (config.CitationClass, TitleType);
Mode = is_valid_parameter_value (cfg.global_cs1_config_t['Mode'], 'cs1 config: mode', cfg.keywords_lists['mode'], ''); -- error messaging 'param' here is a hoax
if is_set(Degree) and "Thesis" == TitleType then -- special case for cite thesis
else
TitleType = Degree .. ' ' .. cfg.title_types ['thesis']:lower();
Mode = is_valid_parameter_value (A['Mode'], A:ORIGIN('Mode'), cfg.keywords_lists['mode'], '');
end
end
end
if is_set(TitleType) then -- if type parameter is specified
TitleType = substitute( cfg.messages['type'], TitleType); -- display it in parentheses
-- TODO: Hack on TitleType to fix bunched parentheses problem
end


if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['Mode'] and utilities.is_set (A['Mode']) then -- when template has |mode=<something> which global setting has overridden
-- legacy: promote PublicationDate to Date if neither Date nor Year are set.
utilities.set_message ('maint_overridden_setting'); -- set a maint message
local Date_origin; -- to hold the name of parameter promoted to Date; required for date error messaging
end


-- separator character and postscript
if not is_set (Date) then
local sepc, PostScript = set_style (Mode:lower(), A['PostScript'], config.CitationClass);
Date = Year; -- promote Year to Date
-- controls capitalization of certain static text
Year = nil; -- make nil so Year as empty string isn't used for CITEREF
local use_lowercase = ( sepc == ',' );
if not is_set (Date) and is_set(PublicationDate) then -- use PublicationDate when |date= and |year= are not set
Date = PublicationDate; -- promote PublicationDate to Date
-- cite map oddities
PublicationDate = ''; -- unset, no longer needed
local Cartography = "";
Date_origin = A:ORIGIN('PublicationDate'); -- save the name of the promoted parameter
local Scale = "";
else
local Sheet = A['Sheet'] or '';
Date_origin = A:ORIGIN('Year'); -- save the name of the promoted parameter
local Sheets = A['Sheets'] or '';
if config.CitationClass == "map" then
if utilities.is_set (Chapter) then --TODO: make a function for this and similar?
utilities.set_message ('err_redundant_parameters', {utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', 'map') .. cfg.presentation['sep_list_pair'] .. utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', Chapter_origin)}); -- add error message
end
Chapter = A['Map'];
Chapter_origin = A:ORIGIN('Map');
ChapterURL = A['MapURL'];
ChapterURL_origin = A:ORIGIN('MapURL');
TransChapter = A['TransMap'];
ScriptChapter = A['ScriptMap']
ScriptChapter_origin = A:ORIGIN('ScriptMap')
 
ChapterUrlAccess = MapUrlAccess;
ChapterFormat = A['MapFormat'];
 
Cartography = A['Cartography'];
if utilities.is_set ( Cartography ) then
Cartography = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('cartography', Cartography, use_lowercase);
end
Scale = A['Scale'];
if utilities.is_set ( Scale ) then
Scale = sepc .. " " .. Scale;
end
end
else
Date_origin = A:ORIGIN('Date'); -- not a promotion; name required for error messaging
end
end


-- Account for the oddities that are {{cite episode}} and {{cite serial}}, before generation of COinS data.
if PublicationDate == Date then PublicationDate = ''; end -- if PublicationDate is same as Date, don't display in rendered citation
local Series = A['Series'];
if 'episode' == config.CitationClass or 'serial' == config.CitationClass then
local SeriesLink = A['SeriesLink'];


SeriesLink = link_title_ok (SeriesLink, A:ORIGIN ('SeriesLink'), Series, 'series'); -- check for wiki-markup in |series-link= or wiki-markup in |series= when |series-link= is set
--[[
 
Go test all of the date-holding parameters for valid MOS:DATE format and make sure that dates are real dates. This must be done before we do COinS because here is where
local Network = A['Network'];
we get the date used in the metadata.
local Station = A['Station'];
local s, n = {}, {};
-- do common parameters first
if utilities.is_set (Network) then table.insert(n, Network); end
if utilities.is_set (Station) then table.insert(n, Station); end
ID = table.concat(n, sepc .. ' ');
if 'episode' == config.CitationClass then -- handle the oddities that are strictly {{cite episode}}
local Season = A['Season'];
local SeriesNumber = A['SeriesNumber'];
 
if utilities.is_set (Season) and utilities.is_set (SeriesNumber) then -- these are mutually exclusive so if both are set TODO: make a function for this and similar?
utilities.set_message ('err_redundant_parameters', {utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', 'season') .. cfg.presentation['sep_list_pair'] .. utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', 'seriesno')}); -- add error message
SeriesNumber = ''; -- unset; prefer |season= over |seriesno=
end
-- assemble a table of parts concatenated later into Series
if utilities.is_set (Season) then table.insert(s, wrap_msg ('season', Season, use_lowercase)); end
if utilities.is_set (SeriesNumber) then table.insert(s, wrap_msg ('seriesnum', SeriesNumber, use_lowercase)); end
if utilities.is_set (Issue) then table.insert(s, wrap_msg ('episode', Issue, use_lowercase)); end
Issue = ''; -- unset because this is not a unique parameter
Chapter = Title; -- promote title parameters to chapter
Date validation supporting code is in Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation
ScriptChapter = ScriptTitle;
]]
ScriptChapter_origin = A:ORIGIN('ScriptTitle');
do -- create defined block to contain local variables error_message, date_parameters_list, mismatch
ChapterLink = TitleLink; -- alias |episode-link=
local error_message = '';
TransChapter = TransTitle;
-- AirDate has been promoted to Date so not necessary to check it
ChapterURL = URL;
-- local date_parameters_list = {['access-date']=AccessDate, ['archive-date']=ArchiveDate, ['date']=Date, ['doi-broken-date']=DoiBroken,
ChapterUrlAccess = UrlAccess;
-- ['embargo']=Embargo, ['lay-date']=LayDate, ['publication-date']=PublicationDate, ['year']=Year};
ChapterURL_origin = URL_origin;
ChapterFormat = Format;


Title = Series; -- promote series to title
local date_parameters_list = {
TitleLink = SeriesLink;
['access-date'] = {val=AccessDate, name=A:ORIGIN ('AccessDate')},
Series = table.concat(s, sepc .. ' '); -- this is concatenation of season, seriesno, episode number
['archive-date'] = {val=ArchiveDate, name=A:ORIGIN ('ArchiveDate')},
['date'] = {val=Date, name=Date_origin},
['doi-broken-date'] = {val=DoiBroken, name=A:ORIGIN ('DoiBroken')},
['embargo'] = {val=Embargo, name=A:ORIGIN ('Embargo')},
['lay-date'] = {val=LayDate, name=A:ORIGIN ('LayDate')},
['publication-date'] ={val=PublicationDate, name=A:ORIGIN ('PublicationDate')},
['year'] = {val=Year, name=A:ORIGIN ('Year')},
};
anchor_year, Embargo, error_message = dates(date_parameters_list, COinS_date);


if utilities.is_set (ChapterLink) and not utilities.is_set (ChapterURL) then -- link but not URL
-- start temporary Julian / Gregorian calendar uncertainty categorization
Chapter = utilities.make_wikilink (ChapterLink, Chapter);
if COinS_date.inter_cal_cat then
elseif utilities.is_set (ChapterLink) and utilities.is_set (ChapterURL) then -- if both are set, URL links episode;
add_prop_cat ('jul_greg_uncertainty');
Series = utilities.make_wikilink (ChapterLink, Series);
end
-- end temporary Julian / Gregorian calendar uncertainty categorization
 
if is_set (Year) and is_set (Date) then -- both |date= and |year= not normally needed;
local mismatch = year_date_check (Year, Date)
if 0 == mismatch then -- |year= does not match a year-value in |date=
if is_set (error_message) then -- if there is already an error message
error_message = error_message .. ', '; -- tack on this additional message
end
error_message = error_message .. '&#124;year= / &#124;date= mismatch';
elseif 1 == mismatch then -- |year= matches year-value in |date=
add_maint_cat ('date_year');
end
end
URL = ''; -- unset
end
TransTitle = '';
ScriptTitle = '';
if not is_set(error_message) then -- error free dates only
Format = '';
local modified = false; -- flag
else -- now oddities that are cite serial
if is_set (DF) then -- if we need to reformat dates
Issue = ''; -- unset because this parameter no longer supported by the citation/core version of cite serial
modified = reformat_dates (date_parameters_list, DF, false); -- reformat to DF format, use long month names if appropriate
Chapter = A['Episode']; -- TODO: make |episode= available to cite episode someday?
if utilities.is_set (Series) and utilities.is_set (SeriesLink) then
Series = utilities.make_wikilink (SeriesLink, Series);
end
end
Series = utilities.wrap_style ('italic-title', Series); -- series is italicized
end
end
-- end of {{cite episode}} stuff


-- handle type parameter for those CS1 citations that have default values
if true == date_hyphen_to_dash (date_parameters_list) then -- convert hyphens to dashes where appropriate
local TitleType = A['TitleType'];
modified = true;
local Degree = A['Degree'];
add_maint_cat ('date_format'); -- hyphens were converted so add maint category
if utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {'AV-media-notes', 'document', 'interview', 'mailinglist', 'map', 'podcast', 'pressrelease', 'report', 'speech', 'techreport', 'thesis'}) then
end
TitleType = set_titletype (config.CitationClass, TitleType);
if utilities.is_set (Degree) and "Thesis" == TitleType then -- special case for cite thesis
-- for those wikis that can and want to have English date names translated to the local language,
TitleType = Degree .. ' ' .. cfg.title_types ['thesis']:lower();
-- uncomment these three lines.  Not supported by en.wiki (for obvious reasons)
end
-- set date_name_xlate() second argument to true to translate English digits to local digits (will translate ymd dates)
end
-- if date_name_xlate (date_parameters_list, false) then
-- modified = true;
-- end


if utilities.is_set (TitleType) then -- if type parameter is specified
if modified then -- if the date_parameters_list values were modified
TitleType = utilities.substitute ( cfg.messages['type'], TitleType); -- display it in parentheses
AccessDate = date_parameters_list['access-date'].val; -- overwrite date holding parameters with modified values
-- TODO: Hack on TitleType to fix bunched parentheses problem
ArchiveDate = date_parameters_list['archive-date'].val;
end
Date = date_parameters_list['date'].val;
 
DoiBroken = date_parameters_list['doi-broken-date'].val;
-- legacy: promote PublicationDate to Date if neither Date nor Year are set.
LayDate = date_parameters_list['lay-date'].val;
local Date = A['Date'];
PublicationDate = date_parameters_list['publication-date'].val;
local Date_origin; -- to hold the name of parameter promoted to Date; required for date error messaging
end
local PublicationDate = A['PublicationDate'];
local Year = A['Year'];
 
if not utilities.is_set (Date) then
Date = Year; -- promote Year to Date
Year = nil; -- make nil so Year as empty string isn't used for CITEREF
if not utilities.is_set (Date) and utilities.is_set (PublicationDate) then -- use PublicationDate when |date= and |year= are not set
Date = PublicationDate; -- promote PublicationDate to Date
PublicationDate = ''; -- unset, no longer needed
Date_origin = A:ORIGIN('PublicationDate'); -- save the name of the promoted parameter
else
else
Date_origin = A:ORIGIN('Year'); -- save the name of the promoted parameter
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'bad_date', {error_message}, true ) } ); -- add this error message
end
end
else
end -- end of do
Date_origin = A:ORIGIN('Date'); -- not a promotion; name required for error messaging
end


if PublicationDate == Date then PublicationDate = ''; end -- if PublicationDate is same as Date, don't display in rendered citation
-- Account for the oddity that is {{cite journal}} with |pmc= set and |url= not set.  Do this after date check but before COInS.
-- Here we unset Embargo if PMC not embargoed (|embargo= not set in the citation) or if the embargo time has expired. Otherwise, holds embargo date
Embargo = is_embargoed (Embargo);


--[[
if config.CitationClass == "journal" and not is_set(URL) and is_set(ID_list['PMC']) then
Go test all of the date-holding parameters for valid MOS:DATE format and make sure that dates are real dates. This must be done before we do COinS because here is where
if not is_set (Embargo) then -- if not embargoed or embargo has expired
we get the date used in the metadata.
URL=cfg.id_handlers['PMC'].prefix .. ID_list['PMC']; -- set url to be the same as the PMC external link if not embargoed
URLorigin = cfg.id_handlers['PMC'].parameters[1]; -- set URLorigin to parameter name for use in error message if citation is missing a |title=
Date validation supporting code is in Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation
if is_set(AccessDate) then -- access date requires |url=; pmc created url is not |url=
]]
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'accessdate_missing_url', {}, true ) } );
AccessDate = ''; -- unset
end


local DF = is_valid_parameter_value (A['DF'], A:ORIGIN('DF'), cfg.keywords_lists['df'], '');
end
if not utilities.is_set (DF) then
DF = cfg.global_df; -- local |df= if present overrides global df set by {{use xxx date}} template
end
end


local ArchiveURL;
-- At this point fields may be nil if they weren't specified in the template use.  We can use that fact.
local ArchiveDate;
-- Test if citation has no title
local ArchiveFormat = A['ArchiveFormat'];
if not is_set(Title) and
local archive_url_timestamp; -- timestamp from wayback machine url
not is_set(TransTitle) and
not is_set(ScriptTitle) then
if 'episode' == config.CitationClass then -- special case for cite episode; TODO: is there a better way to do this?
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'citation_missing_title', {'series'}, true ) } );
else
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'citation_missing_title', {'title'}, true ) } );
end
end
ArchiveURL, ArchiveDate, archive_url_timestamp = archive_url_check (A['ArchiveURL'], A['ArchiveDate'])
if 'none' == Title and in_array (config.CitationClass, {'journal', 'citation'}) and is_set (Periodical) and 'journal' == A:ORIGIN('Periodical') then -- special case for journal cites
ArchiveFormat = style_format (ArchiveFormat, ArchiveURL, 'archive-format', 'archive-url');
Title = ''; -- set title to empty string
add_maint_cat ('untitled');
ArchiveURL, ArchiveDate = is_unique_archive_url (ArchiveURL, URL, ChapterURL, A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL'), ArchiveDate); -- add error message when URL or ChapterURL == ArchiveURL
end
 
local AccessDate = A['AccessDate'];
-- local LayDate = A['LayDate'];
local COinS_date = {}; -- holds date info extracted from |date= for the COinS metadata by Module:Date verification
local DoiBroken = A['DoiBroken'];
local Embargo = A['Embargo'];
local anchor_year; -- used in the CITEREF identifier
do -- create defined block to contain local variables error_message, date_parameters_list, mismatch
local error_message = '';
-- AirDate has been promoted to Date so not necessary to check it
local date_parameters_list = {
['access-date'] = {val = AccessDate, name = A:ORIGIN ('AccessDate')},
['archive-date'] = {val = ArchiveDate, name = A:ORIGIN ('ArchiveDate')},
['date'] = {val = Date, name = Date_origin},
['doi-broken-date'] = {val = DoiBroken, name = A:ORIGIN ('DoiBroken')},
['pmc-embargo-date'] = {val = Embargo, name = A:ORIGIN ('Embargo')},
-- ['lay-date'] = {val = LayDate, name = A:ORIGIN ('LayDate')},
['publication-date'] = {val = PublicationDate, name = A:ORIGIN ('PublicationDate')},
['year'] = {val = Year, name = A:ORIGIN ('Year')},
};


local error_list = {};
check_for_url ({ -- add error message when any of these parameters contains a URL
anchor_year, Embargo = validation.dates(date_parameters_list, COinS_date, error_list);
['title']=Title,
[A:ORIGIN('Chapter')]=Chapter,
[A:ORIGIN('Periodical')]=Periodical,
[A:ORIGIN('PublisherName')] = PublisherName
});


-- start temporary Julian / Gregorian calendar uncertainty categorization
-- COinS metadata (see <http://ocoins.info/>) for automated parsing of citation information.
if COinS_date.inter_cal_cat then
-- handle the oddity that is cite encyclopedia and {{citation |encyclopedia=something}}. Here we presume that
utilities.add_prop_cat ('jul-greg-uncertainty');
-- when Periodical, Title, and Chapter are all set, then Periodical is the book (encyclopedia) title, Title
-- is the article title, and Chapter is a section within the article.  So, we remap
local coins_chapter = Chapter; -- default assuming that remapping not required
local coins_title = Title; -- et tu
if 'encyclopaedia' == config.CitationClass or ('citation' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Encyclopedia)) then
if is_set (Chapter) and is_set (Title) and is_set (Periodical) then -- if all are used then
coins_chapter = Title; -- remap
coins_title = Periodical;
end
end
-- end temporary Julian / Gregorian calendar uncertainty categorization
end
local coins_author = a; -- default for coins rft.au
if 0 < #c then -- but if contributor list
coins_author = c; -- use that instead
end
 
-- this is the function call to COinS()
local OCinSoutput = COinS({
['Periodical'] = Periodical,
['Encyclopedia'] = Encyclopedia,
['Chapter'] = make_coins_title (coins_chapter, ScriptChapter), -- Chapter and ScriptChapter stripped of bold / italic wikimarkup
['Degree'] = Degree; -- cite thesis only
['Title'] = make_coins_title (coins_title, ScriptTitle), -- Title and ScriptTitle stripped of bold / italic wikimarkup
['PublicationPlace'] = PublicationPlace,
['Date'] = COinS_date.rftdate, -- COinS_date has correctly formatted date if Date is valid;
['Season'] = COinS_date.rftssn,
['Chron'] =  COinS_date.rftchron or (not COinS_date.rftdate and Date) or '', -- chron but if not set and invalid date format use Date; keep this last bit?
['Series'] = Series,
['Volume'] = Volume,
['Issue'] = Issue,
['Pages'] = get_coins_pages (first_set ({Sheet, Sheets, Page, Pages, At}, 5)), -- pages stripped of external links
['Edition'] = Edition,
['PublisherName'] = PublisherName,
['URL'] = first_set ({ChapterURL, URL}, 2),
['Authors'] = coins_author,
['ID_list'] = ID_list,
['RawPage'] = this_page.prefixedText,
}, config.CitationClass);
 
-- Account for the oddities that are {{cite arxiv}}, {{cite biorxiv}}, and {{cite citeseerx}} AFTER generation of COinS data.
if in_array (config.CitationClass, {'arxiv', 'biorxiv', 'citeseerx'}) then -- we have set rft.jtitle in COinS to arXiv, bioRxiv, or CiteSeerX now unset so it isn't displayed
Periodical = ''; -- periodical not allowed in these templates; if article has been published, use cite journal
end


if utilities.is_set (Year) and utilities.is_set (Date) then -- both |date= and |year= not normally needed;
-- special case for cite newsgroup.  Do this after COinS because we are modifying Publishername to include some static text
validation.year_date_check (Year, A:ORIGIN ('Year'), Date, A:ORIGIN ('Date'), error_list);
if 'newsgroup' == config.CitationClass then
if is_set (PublisherName) then
PublisherName = substitute (cfg.messages['newsgroup'], external_link( 'news:' .. PublisherName, PublisherName, A:ORIGIN('PublisherName'), nil ));
end
end
end
if 0 == #error_list then -- error free dates only; 0 when error_list is empty
 
local modified = false; -- flag
if utilities.is_set (DF) then -- if we need to reformat dates
modified = validation.reformat_dates (date_parameters_list, DF); -- reformat to DF format, use long month names if appropriate
end


if true == validation.date_hyphen_to_dash (date_parameters_list) then -- convert hyphens to dashes where appropriate
modified = true;
utilities.set_message ('maint_date_format'); -- hyphens were converted so add maint category
end
-- for those wikis that can and want to have English date names translated to the local language; not supported at en.wiki
if cfg.date_name_auto_xlate_enable and validation.date_name_xlate (date_parameters_list, cfg.date_digit_auto_xlate_enable ) then
utilities.set_message ('maint_date_auto_xlated'); -- add maint cat
modified = true;
end


if modified then -- if the date_parameters_list values were modified
-- Now perform various field substitutions.
AccessDate = date_parameters_list['access-date'].val; -- overwrite date holding parameters with modified values
-- We also add leading spaces and surrounding markup and punctuation to the
ArchiveDate = date_parameters_list['archive-date'].val;
-- various parts of the citation, but only when they are non-nil.
Date = date_parameters_list['date'].val;
local EditorCount; -- used only for choosing {ed.) or (eds.) annotation at end of editor name-list
DoiBroken = date_parameters_list['doi-broken-date'].val;
do
-- LayDate = date_parameters_list['lay-date'].val;
local last_first_list;
PublicationDate = date_parameters_list['publication-date'].val;
local control = {
end
format = NameListFormat, -- empty string or 'vanc'
maximum = nil, -- as if display-authors or display-editors not set
lastauthoramp = LastAuthorAmp,
page_name = this_page.text, -- get current page name so that we don't wikilink to it via editorlinkn
mode = Mode
};


if archive_url_timestamp and utilities.is_set (ArchiveDate) then
do -- do editor name list first because the now unsupported coauthors used to modify control table
validation.archive_date_check (ArchiveDate, archive_url_timestamp); -- does YYYYMMDD in archive_url_timestamp match date in ArchiveDate
control.maximum , editor_etal = get_display_authors_editors (A['DisplayEditors'], #e, 'editors', editor_etal);
end
last_first_list, EditorCount = list_people(control, e, editor_etal);
else
utilities.set_message ('err_bad_date', {utilities.make_sep_list (#error_list, error_list)}); -- add this error message
end
end -- end of do


if utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {'book', 'encyclopaedia'}) or -- {{cite book}}, {{cite encyclopedia}}; TODO: {{cite conference}} and others?
if is_set (Editors) then
('citation' == config.CitationClass and utilities.is_set (Encyclopedia)) or -- {{citation}} as an encylopedia citation
if editor_etal then
('citation' == config.CitationClass and not utilities.is_set (Periodical)) then -- {{citation}} as a book citation
Editors = Editors .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['et al']; -- add et al. to editors parameter beause |display-editors=etal
if utilities.is_set (PublicationPlace) then
EditorCount = 2; -- with et al., |editors= is multiple names; spoof to display (eds.) annotation
if not utilities.is_set (PublisherName) then
else
local date = COinS_date.rftdate and tonumber (COinS_date.rftdate:match ('%d%d%d%d')); -- get year portion of COinS date (because in Arabic numerals); convert string to number
EditorCount = 2; -- we don't know but assume |editors= is multiple names; spoof to display (eds.) annotation
if date and (1850 <= date) then -- location has no publisher; if date is 1850 or later
utilities.set_message ('maint_location_no_publisher'); -- add maint cat
end
else -- PublisherName has a value
if cfg.keywords_xlate['none'] == PublisherName then -- if that value is 'none' (only for book and encyclopedia citations)
PublisherName = ''; -- unset
end
end
end
else
Editors = last_first_list; -- either an author name list or an empty string
end
end
end


local ID_list = {}; -- sequence table of rendered identifiers
if 1 == EditorCount and (true == editor_etal or 1 < #e) then -- only one editor displayed but includes etal then
local ID_list_coins = {}; -- table of identifiers and their values from args; key is same as cfg.id_handlers's key
EditorCount = 2; -- spoof to display (eds.) annotation
local Class = A['Class']; -- arxiv class identifier
end
end
local ID_support = {
do -- now do interviewers
{A['ASINTLD'], 'ASIN', 'err_asintld_missing_asin', A:ORIGIN ('ASINTLD')},
control.maximum = #interviewers_list; -- number of interviewerss
{DoiBroken, 'DOI', 'err_doibroken_missing_doi', A:ORIGIN ('DoiBroken')},
Interviewers = list_people(control, interviewers_list, false); -- et al not currently supported
{Embargo, 'PMC', 'err_embargo_missing_pmc', A:ORIGIN ('Embargo')},
end
}
do -- now do translators
control.maximum = #t; -- number of translators
Translators = list_people(control, t, false); -- et al not currently supported
end
do -- now do contributors
control.maximum = #c; -- number of contributors
Contributors = list_people(control, c, false); -- et al not currently supported
end
do -- now do authors
control.maximum , author_etal = get_display_authors_editors (A['DisplayAuthors'], #a, 'authors', author_etal);


ID_list, ID_list_coins = identifiers.identifier_lists_get (args, {DoiBroken = DoiBroken, ASINTLD = A['ASINTLD'], Embargo = Embargo, Class = Class}, ID_support);
last_first_list = list_people(control, a, author_etal);


-- Account for the oddities that are {{cite arxiv}}, {{cite biorxiv}}, {{cite citeseerx}}, {{cite medrxiv}}, {{cite ssrn}}, before generation of COinS data.
if is_set (Authors) then
if utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, whitelist.preprint_template_list_t) then -- |arxiv= or |eprint= required for cite arxiv; |biorxiv=, |citeseerx=, |medrxiv=, |ssrn= required for their templates
Authors, author_etal = name_has_etal (Authors, author_etal, false); -- find and remove variations on et al.
if not (args[cfg.id_handlers[config.CitationClass:upper()].parameters[1]] or -- can't use ID_list_coins k/v table here because invalid parameters omitted
if author_etal then
args[cfg.id_handlers[config.CitationClass:upper()].parameters[2]]) then -- which causes unexpected parameter missing error message
Authors = Authors .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['et al']; -- add et al. to authors parameter
utilities.set_message ('err_' .. config.CitationClass .. '_missing'); -- add error message
end
else
Authors = last_first_list; -- either an author name list or an empty string
end
end -- end of do
if is_set (Authors) and is_set (Collaboration) then
Authors = Authors .. ' (' .. Collaboration .. ')'; -- add collaboration after et al.
end
end


Periodical = ({['arxiv'] = 'arXiv', ['biorxiv'] = 'bioRxiv', ['citeseerx'] = 'CiteSeerX', ['medrxiv'] = 'medRxiv', ['ssrn'] = 'Social Science Research Network'})[config.CitationClass];
end
end


-- Link the title of the work if no |url= was provided, but we have a |pmc= or a |doi= with |doi-access=free
-- apply |[xx-]format= styling; at the end, these parameters hold correctly styled format annotation,
-- an error message if the associated url is not set, or an empty string for concatenation
ArchiveFormat = style_format (ArchiveFormat, ArchiveURL, 'archive-format', 'archive-url');
ConferenceFormat = style_format (ConferenceFormat, ConferenceURL, 'conference-format', 'conference-url');
Format = style_format (Format, URL, 'format', 'url');
LayFormat = style_format (LayFormat, LayURL, 'lay-format', 'lay-url');
TranscriptFormat = style_format (TranscriptFormat, TranscriptURL, 'transcript-format', 'transcripturl');


if config.CitationClass == "journal" and not utilities.is_set (URL) and not utilities.is_set (TitleLink) and not utilities.in_array (cfg.keywords_xlate[Title], {'off', 'none'}) then -- TODO: remove 'none' once existing citations have been switched to 'off', so 'none' can be used as token for "no title" instead
-- special case for chapter format so no error message or cat when chapter not supported
if 'none' ~= cfg.keywords_xlate[auto_select] then -- if auto-linking not disabled
if not (in_array(config.CitationClass, {'web', 'news', 'journal', 'magazine', 'pressrelease', 'podcast', 'newsgroup', 'arxiv', 'biorxiv', 'citeseerx'}) or
if identifiers.auto_link_urls[auto_select] then -- manual selection
('citation' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Periodical) and not is_set (Encyclopedia))) then
URL = identifiers.auto_link_urls[auto_select]; -- set URL to be the same as identifier's external link
ChapterFormat = style_format (ChapterFormat, ChapterURL, 'chapter-format', 'chapter-url');
URL_origin = cfg.id_handlers[auto_select:upper()].parameters[1]; -- set URL_origin to parameter name for use in error message if citation is missing a |title=
end
elseif identifiers.auto_link_urls['pmc'] then -- auto-select PMC
URL = identifiers.auto_link_urls['pmc']; -- set URL to be the same as the PMC external link if not embargoed
URL_origin = cfg.id_handlers['PMC'].parameters[1]; -- set URL_origin to parameter name for use in error message if citation is missing a |title=
elseif identifiers.auto_link_urls['doi'] then -- auto-select DOI
URL = identifiers.auto_link_urls['doi'];
URL_origin = cfg.id_handlers['DOI'].parameters[1];
end
end
 
if utilities.is_set (URL) then -- set when using an identifier-created URL
if utilities.is_set (AccessDate) then -- |access-date= requires |url=; identifier-created URL is not |url=
utilities.set_message ('err_accessdate_missing_url'); -- add an error message
AccessDate = ''; -- unset
end


if utilities.is_set (ArchiveURL) then -- |archive-url= requires |url=; identifier-created URL is not |url=
if not is_set(URL) then
utilities.set_message ('err_archive_missing_url'); -- add an error message
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"web","podcast", "mailinglist"}) then -- |url= required for cite web, cite podcast, and cite mailinglist
ArchiveURL = ''; -- unset
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'cite_web_url', {}, true ) } );
end
end
-- do we have |accessdate= without either |url= or |chapter-url=?
if is_set(AccessDate) and not is_set(ChapterURL)then -- ChapterURL may be set when URL is not set;
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'accessdate_missing_url', {}, true ) } );
AccessDate = '';
end
end
end
end


-- At this point fields may be nil if they weren't specified in the template use.  We can use that fact.
local OriginalURL, OriginalURLorigin, OriginalFormat, OriginalAccess;
-- Test if citation has no title
DeadURL = DeadURL:lower(); -- used later when assembling archived text
if not utilities.is_set (Title) and not utilities.is_set (TransTitle) and not utilities.is_set (ScriptTitle) then -- has special case for cite episode
if is_set( ArchiveURL ) then
utilities.set_message ('err_citation_missing_title', {'episode' == config.CitationClass and 'series' or 'title'});
if is_set (ChapterURL) then -- if chapter-url is set apply archive url to it
OriginalURL = ChapterURL; -- save copy of source chapter's url for archive text
OriginalURLorigin = ChapterURLorigin; -- name of chapter-url parameter for error messages
OriginalFormat = ChapterFormat; -- and original |chapter-format=
if 'no' ~= DeadURL then
ChapterURL = ArchiveURL -- swap-in the archive's url
ChapterURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL') -- name of archive-url parameter for error messages
ChapterFormat = ArchiveFormat or ''; -- swap in archive's format
ChapterUrlAccess = nil; -- restricted access levels do not make sense for archived urls
end
elseif is_set (URL) then
OriginalURL = URL; -- save copy of original source URL
OriginalURLorigin = URLorigin; -- name of url parameter for error messages
OriginalFormat = Format; -- and original |format=
OriginalAccess = UrlAccess;
if 'no' ~= DeadURL then -- if URL set then archive-url applies to it
URL = ArchiveURL -- swap-in the archive's url
URLorigin = A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL') -- name of archive url parameter for error messages
Format = ArchiveFormat or ''; -- swap in archive's format
UrlAccess = nil; -- restricted access levels do not make sense for archived urls
end
end
end
end


if utilities.in_array (cfg.keywords_xlate[Title], {'off', 'none'}) and
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {'web','news','journal', 'magazine', 'pressrelease', 'podcast', 'newsgroup', 'arxiv', 'biorxiv', 'citeseerx'}) or -- if any of the 'periodical' cites except encyclopedia
utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {'journal', 'citation'}) and
('citation' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Periodical) and not is_set (Encyclopedia)) then
(utilities.is_set (Periodical) or utilities.is_set (ScriptPeriodical)) and
local chap_param;
('journal' == Periodical_origin or 'script-journal' == ScriptPeriodical_origin) then -- special case for journal cites
if is_set (Chapter) then -- get a parameter name from one of these chapter related meta-parameters
Title = ''; -- set title to empty string
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('Chapter')
utilities.set_message ('maint_untitled'); -- add maint cat
elseif is_set (TransChapter) then
end
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('TransChapter')
elseif is_set (ChapterURL) then
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('ChapterURL')
elseif is_set (ScriptChapter) then
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('ScriptChapter')
else is_set (ChapterFormat)
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('ChapterFormat')
end


-- COinS metadata (see <http://ocoins.info/>) for automated parsing of citation information.
if is_set (chap_param) then -- if we found one
-- handle the oddity that is cite encyclopedia and {{citation |encyclopedia=something}}. Here we presume that
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'chapter_ignored', {chap_param}, true ) } ); -- add error message
-- when Periodical, Title, and Chapter are all set, then Periodical is the book (encyclopedia) title, Title
Chapter = ''; -- and set them to empty string to be safe with concatenation
-- is the article title, and Chapter is a section within the article.  So, we remap
TransChapter = '';
ChapterURL = '';
local coins_chapter = Chapter; -- default assuming that remapping not required
ScriptChapter = '';
local coins_title = Title; -- et tu
ChapterFormat = '';
if 'encyclopaedia' == config.CitationClass or ('citation' == config.CitationClass and utilities.is_set (Encyclopedia)) then
end
if utilities.is_set (Chapter) and utilities.is_set (Title) and utilities.is_set (Periodical) then -- if all are used then
else -- otherwise, format chapter / article title
coins_chapter = Title; -- remap
local no_quotes = false; -- default assume that we will be quoting the chapter parameter value
coins_title = Periodical;
if is_set (Contribution) and 0 < #c then -- if this is a contribution with contributor(s)
if in_array (Contribution:lower(), cfg.keywords.contribution) then -- and a generic contribution title
no_quotes = true; -- then render it unquoted
end
end
 
Chapter = format_chapter_title (ScriptChapter, Chapter, TransChapter, ChapterURL, ChapterURLorigin, no_quotes, ChapterUrlAccess); -- Contribution is also in Chapter
if is_set (Chapter) then
Chapter = Chapter .. ChapterFormat ;
if 'map' == config.CitationClass and is_set (TitleType) then
Chapter = Chapter .. ' ' .. TitleType; -- map annotation here; not after title
end
Chapter = Chapter.. sepc .. ' ';
elseif is_set (ChapterFormat) then -- |chapter= not set but |chapter-format= is so ...
Chapter = ChapterFormat .. sepc .. ' '; -- ... ChapterFormat has error message, we want to see it
end
end
end
end
local coins_author = a; -- default for coins rft.au
 
if 0 < #c then -- but if contributor list
-- Format main title.
coins_author = c; -- use that instead
if '...' == Title:sub (-3) then -- if elipsis is the last three characters of |title=
Title = mw.ustring.gsub (Title, '(%.%.%.)%.+$', '%1'); -- limit the number of dots to three
elseif not mw.ustring.find (Title, '%.%s*%a%.') then -- end of title is not a 'dot-(optional space-)letter-dot' initialism
Title = mw.ustring.gsub(Title, '%'..sepc..'$', ''); -- remove any trailing separator character
end
if is_set(TitleLink) and is_set(Title) then
Title = make_wikilink (TitleLink, Title);
end
 
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {'web', 'news', 'journal', 'magazine', 'pressrelease', 'podcast', 'newsgroup', 'mailinglist', 'interview', 'arxiv', 'biorxiv', 'citeseerx'}) or
('citation' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Periodical) and not is_set (Encyclopedia)) or
('map' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Periodical)) then -- special case for cite map when the map is in a periodical treat as an article
Title = kern_quotes (Title); -- if necessary, separate title's leading and trailing quote marks from Module provided quote marks
Title = wrap_style ('quoted-title', Title);
Title = script_concatenate (Title, ScriptTitle); -- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; must be done after title is wrapped
TransTitle= wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', TransTitle );
elseif 'report' == config.CitationClass then -- no styling for cite report
Title = script_concatenate (Title, ScriptTitle); -- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; must be done after title is wrapped
TransTitle= wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', TransTitle ); -- for cite report, use this form for trans-title
else
Title = wrap_style ('italic-title', Title);
Title = script_concatenate (Title, ScriptTitle); -- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; must be done after title is wrapped
TransTitle = wrap_style ('trans-italic-title', TransTitle);
end
 
local TransError = "";
if is_set(TransTitle) then
if is_set(Title) then
TransTitle = " " .. TransTitle;
else
TransError = " " .. set_error( 'trans_missing_title', {'title'} );
end
end
end
-- this is the function call to COinS()
if is_set(Title) then
local OCinSoutput = metadata.COinS({
if not is_set(TitleLink) and is_set(URL) then
['Periodical'] = utilities.strip_apostrophe_markup (Periodical), -- no markup in the metadata
['Encyclopedia'] = Encyclopedia, -- just a flag; content ignored by ~/COinS
Title = external_link( URL, Title, URLorigin, UrlAccess ) .. TransTitle .. TransError .. Format;
['Chapter'] = metadata.make_coins_title (coins_chapter, ScriptChapter), -- Chapter and ScriptChapter stripped of bold / italic / accept-as-written markup
URL = ''; -- unset these because no longer needed
['Degree'] = Degree; -- cite thesis only
Format = "";
['Title'] = metadata.make_coins_title (coins_title, ScriptTitle), -- Title and ScriptTitle stripped of bold / italic / accept-as-written markup
else
['PublicationPlace'] = PublicationPlace,
Title = Title .. TransTitle .. TransError;
['Date'] = COinS_date.rftdate, -- COinS_date.* has correctly formatted date values if Date is valid;
end
['Season'] = COinS_date.rftssn,
else
['Quarter'] = COinS_date.rftquarter,
Title = TransTitle .. TransError;
['Chron'] =  COinS_date.rftchron,
end
['Series'] = Series,
['Volume'] = Volume,
['Issue'] = Issue,
['ArticleNumber'] = ArticleNumber,
['Pages'] = coins_pages or metadata.get_coins_pages (first_set ({Sheet, Sheets, Page, Pages, At, QuotePage, QuotePages}, 7)), -- pages stripped of external links
['Edition'] = Edition,
['PublisherName'] = PublisherName or Newsgroup, -- any apostrophe markup already removed from PublisherName
['URL'] = first_set ({ChapterURL, URL}, 2),
['Authors'] = coins_author,
['ID_list'] = ID_list_coins,
['RawPage'] = this_page.prefixedText,
}, config.CitationClass);


-- Account for the oddities that are {{cite arxiv}}, {{cite biorxiv}}, {{cite citeseerx}}, {{cite medrxiv}}, and {{cite ssrn}} AFTER generation of COinS data.
if is_set(Place) then
if utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, whitelist.preprint_template_list_t) then -- we have set rft.jtitle in COinS to arXiv, bioRxiv, CiteSeerX, medRxiv, or ssrn now unset so it isn't displayed
Place = " " .. wrap_msg ('written', Place, use_lowercase) .. sepc .. " ";
Periodical = ''; -- periodical not allowed in these templates; if article has been published, use cite journal
end
end


-- special case for cite newsgroup.  Do this after COinS because we are modifying Publishername to include some static text
if is_set (Conference) then
if 'newsgroup' == config.CitationClass and utilities.is_set (Newsgroup) then
if is_set (ConferenceURL) then
PublisherName = utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['newsgroup'], external_link( 'news:' .. Newsgroup, Newsgroup, Newsgroup_origin, nil ));
Conference = external_link( ConferenceURL, Conference, ConferenceURLorigin, nil );
end
Conference = sepc .. " " .. Conference .. ConferenceFormat;
elseif is_set(ConferenceURL) then
Conference = sepc .. " " .. external_link( ConferenceURL, nil, ConferenceURLorigin, nil );
end
end


local Editors;
if not is_set(Position) then
local EditorCount; -- used only for choosing {ed.) or (eds.) annotation at end of editor name-list
local Minutes = A['Minutes'];
local Contributors; -- assembled contributors name list
local Time = A['Time'];
local contributor_etal;
 
local Translators; -- assembled translators name list
if is_set(Minutes) then
local translator_etal;
if is_set (Time) then
local t = {}; -- translators list from |translator-lastn= / translator-firstn= pairs
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'minutes') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'time')}, true ) } );
t = extract_names (args, 'TranslatorList'); -- fetch translator list from |translatorn= / |translator-lastn=, -firstn=, -linkn=, -maskn=
end
local Interviewers;
Position = " " .. Minutes .. " " .. cfg.messages['minutes'];
local interviewers_list = {};
else
interviewers_list = extract_names (args, 'InterviewerList'); -- process preferred interviewers parameters
if is_set(Time) then
local interviewer_etal;
local TimeCaption = A['TimeCaption']
if not is_set(TimeCaption) then
-- Now perform various field substitutions.
TimeCaption = cfg.messages['event'];
-- We also add leading spaces and surrounding markup and punctuation to the
if sepc ~= '.' then
-- various parts of the citation, but only when they are non-nil.
TimeCaption = TimeCaption:lower();
do
end
local last_first_list;
end
local control = {
Position = " " .. TimeCaption .. " " .. Time;
format = NameListStyle, -- empty string, '&', 'amp', 'and', or 'vanc'
maximum = nil, -- as if display-authors or display-editors not set
mode = Mode
};
 
do -- do editor name list first because the now unsupported coauthors used to modify control table
if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayEditors'] then -- global setting from {{cs1 config}} overrides local setting
control.maximum , editor_etal = get_display_names (cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayEditors'], #e, 'editors', editor_etal, 'cs1 config');
else
control.maximum , editor_etal = get_display_names (A['DisplayEditors'], #e, 'editors', editor_etal, A:ORIGIN ('DisplayEditors'));
end
end
end
else
Position = " " .. Position;
At = '';
end


if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayEditors'] and utilities.is_set (A['DisplayEditors']) then -- when template has |display-editors=<something> which global setting has overridden
Page, Pages, Sheet, Sheets = format_pages_sheets (Page, Pages, Sheet, Sheets, config.CitationClass, Periodical_origin, sepc, NoPP, use_lowercase);
utilities.set_message ('maint_overridden_setting'); -- set a maint message
end


Editors, EditorCount = list_people (control, e, editor_etal);
At = is_set(At) and (sepc .. " " .. At) or "";
Position = is_set(Position) and (sepc .. " " .. Position) or "";
if config.CitationClass == 'map' then
local Section = A['Section'];
local Sections = A['Sections'];
local Inset = A['Inset'];
if is_set( Inset ) then
Inset = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('inset', Inset, use_lowercase);
end


if 1 == EditorCount and (true == editor_etal or 1 < #e) then -- only one editor displayed but includes etal then  
if is_set( Sections ) then
EditorCount = 2; -- spoof to display (eds.) annotation
Section = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('sections', Sections, use_lowercase);
end
elseif is_set( Section ) then
Section = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('section', Section, use_lowercase);
end
end
do -- now do interviewers
At = At .. Inset .. Section;
if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayInterviewers'] then -- global setting from {{cs1 config}} overrides local setting
end
control.maximum, interviewer_etal = get_display_names (cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayInterviewers'], #interviewers_list, 'interviewers', interviewer_etal, 'cs1 config');
else
control.maximum, interviewer_etal = get_display_names (A['DisplayInterviewers'], #interviewers_list, 'interviewers', interviewer_etal, A:ORIGIN ('DisplayInterviewers'));
end


if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayInterviewers'] and utilities.is_set (A['DisplayInterviewers']) then -- when template has |display-interviewers=<something> which global setting has overridden
if is_set (Language) then
utilities.set_message ('maint_overridden_setting'); -- set a maint message
Language = language_parameter (Language); -- format, categories, name from ISO639-1, etc
end
else
Language=""; -- language not specified so make sure this is an empty string;
--[[ TODO: need to extract the wrap_msg from language_parameter
so that we can solve parentheses bunching problem with Format/Language/TitleType
]]
end


Interviewers = list_people (control, interviewers_list, interviewer_etal);
Others = is_set(Others) and (sepc .. " " .. Others) or "";
if is_set (Translators) then
Others = safe_join ({sepc .. ' ', wrap_msg ('translated', Translators, use_lowercase), Others}, sepc);
end
if is_set (Interviewers) then
Others = safe_join ({sepc .. ' ', wrap_msg ('interview', Interviewers, use_lowercase), Others}, sepc);
end
TitleNote = is_set(TitleNote) and (sepc .. " " .. TitleNote) or "";
if is_set (Edition) then
if Edition:match ('%f[%a][Ee]d%.?$') or Edition:match ('%f[%a][Ee]dition$') then
add_maint_cat ('extra_text', 'edition');
end
end
do -- now do translators
Edition = " " .. wrap_msg ('edition', Edition);
if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayTranslators'] then -- global setting from {{cs1 config}} overrides local setting
else
control.maximum, translator_etal = get_display_names (cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayTranslators'], #t, 'translators', translator_etal, 'cs1 config');
Edition = '';
else
end
control.maximum, translator_etal = get_display_names (A['DisplayTranslators'], #t, 'translators', translator_etal, A:ORIGIN ('DisplayTranslators'));
 
end
Series = is_set(Series) and (sepc .. " " .. Series) or "";
OrigYear = is_set(OrigYear) and (" [" .. OrigYear .. "]") or ""; -- TODO: presentation


if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayTranslators'] and utilities.is_set (A['DisplayTranslators']) then -- when template has |display-translators=<something> which global setting has overridden
Agency = is_set(Agency) and (sepc .. " " .. Agency) or "";
utilities.set_message ('maint_overridden_setting'); -- set a maint message
end


Translators = list_people (control, t, translator_etal);
Volume = format_volume_issue (Volume, Issue, config.CitationClass, Periodical_origin, sepc, use_lowercase);
end
do -- now do contributors
if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayContributors'] then -- global setting from {{cs1 config}} overrides local setting
control.maximum, contributor_etal = get_display_names (cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayContributors'], #c, 'contributors', contributor_etal, 'cs1 config');
else
control.maximum, contributor_etal = get_display_names (A['DisplayContributors'], #c, 'contributors', contributor_etal, A:ORIGIN ('DisplayContributors'));
end


if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayContributors'] and utilities.is_set (A['DisplayContributors']) then -- when template has |display-contributors=<something> which global setting has overridden
------------------------------------ totally unrelated data
utilities.set_message ('maint_overridden_setting'); -- set a maint message
if is_set(Via) then
end
Via = " " .. wrap_msg ('via', Via);
end


Contributors = list_people (control, c, contributor_etal);
--[[
end
Subscription implies paywall; Registration does not.  If both are used in a citation, the subscription required link
do -- now do authors
note is displayed. There are no error messages for this condition.
if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayAuthors'] then -- global setting from {{cs1 config}} overrides local setting
control.maximum, author_etal = get_display_names (cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayAuthors'], #a, 'authors', author_etal, 'cs1 config');
]]
else
if is_set (SubscriptionRequired) then
control.maximum, author_etal = get_display_names (A['DisplayAuthors'], #a, 'authors', author_etal, A:ORIGIN ('DisplayAuthors'));
SubscriptionRequired = sepc .. " " .. cfg.messages['subscription']; -- subscription required message
end
elseif is_set (RegistrationRequired) then
SubscriptionRequired = sepc .. " " .. cfg.messages['registration']; -- registration required message
else
SubscriptionRequired = ''; -- either or both might be set to something other than yes true y
end


if cfg.global_cs1_config_t['DisplayAuthors'] and utilities.is_set (A['DisplayAuthors']) then -- when template has |display-authors=<something> which global setting has overridden
if is_set(AccessDate) then
utilities.set_message ('maint_overridden_setting'); -- set a maint message
local retrv_text = " " .. cfg.messages['retrieved']
end


last_first_list = list_people (control, a, author_etal);
AccessDate = nowrap_date (AccessDate); -- wrap in nowrap span if date in appropriate format
if (sepc ~= ".") then retrv_text = retrv_text:lower() end -- if mode is cs2, lower case
AccessDate = substitute (retrv_text, AccessDate); -- add retrieved text


if utilities.is_set (Authors) then
AccessDate = substitute (cfg.presentation['accessdate'], {sepc, AccessDate}); -- allow editors to hide accessdates
Authors, author_etal = name_has_etal (Authors, author_etal, false, 'authors'); -- find and remove variations on et al.
end
if author_etal then
Authors = Authors .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['et al']; -- add et al. to authors parameter
end
else
Authors = last_first_list; -- either an author name list or an empty string
end
end -- end of do
if utilities.is_set (Authors) and utilities.is_set (Collaboration) then
if is_set(ID) then ID = sepc .." ".. ID; end
Authors = Authors .. ' (' .. Collaboration .. ')'; -- add collaboration after et al.
  if "thesis" == config.CitationClass and is_set(Docket) then
end
ID = sepc .." Docket ".. Docket .. ID;
end
  if "report" == config.CitationClass and is_set(Docket) then -- for cite report when |docket= is set
ID = sepc .. ' ' .. Docket; -- overwrite ID even if |id= is set
end
 
ID_list = build_id_list( ID_list, {IdAccessLevels=ID_access_levels, DoiBroken = DoiBroken, ASINTLD = ASINTLD, IgnoreISBN = IgnoreISBN, Embargo=Embargo, Class = Class} );


if is_set(URL) then
URL = " " .. external_link( URL, nil, URLorigin, UrlAccess );
end
end


local ConferenceFormat = A['ConferenceFormat'];
if is_set(Quote) then
local ConferenceURL = A['ConferenceURL'];
if Quote:sub(1,1) == '"' and Quote:sub(-1,-1) == '"' then -- if first and last characters of quote are quote marks
ConferenceFormat = style_format (ConferenceFormat, ConferenceURL, 'conference-format', 'conference-url');
Quote = Quote:sub(2,-2); -- strip them off
Format = style_format (Format, URL, 'format', 'url');
end
 
Quote = sepc .." " .. wrap_style ('quoted-text', Quote ); -- wrap in <q>...</q> tags
-- special case for chapter format so no error message or cat when chapter not supported
PostScript = ""; -- cs1|2 does not supply terminal punctuation when |quote= is set
if not (utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {'web', 'news', 'journal', 'magazine', 'pressrelease', 'podcast', 'newsgroup', 'arxiv', 'biorxiv', 'citeseerx', 'medrxiv', 'ssrn'}) or
('citation' == config.CitationClass and (utilities.is_set (Periodical) or utilities.is_set (ScriptPeriodical)) and not utilities.is_set (Encyclopedia))) then
ChapterFormat = style_format (ChapterFormat, ChapterURL, 'chapter-format', 'chapter-url');
end
end
 
if not utilities.is_set (URL) then
local Archived
if utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {"web", "podcast", "mailinglist"}) or -- |url= required for cite web, cite podcast, and cite mailinglist
if is_set(ArchiveURL) then
('citation' == config.CitationClass and ('website' == Periodical_origin or 'script-website' == ScriptPeriodical_origin)) then -- and required for {{citation}} with |website= or |script-website=
if not is_set(ArchiveDate) then
utilities.set_message ('err_cite_web_url');
ArchiveDate = set_error('archive_missing_date');
end
if "no" == DeadURL then
local arch_text = cfg.messages['archived'];
if sepc ~= "." then arch_text = arch_text:lower() end
Archived = sepc .. " " .. substitute( cfg.messages['archived-not-dead'],
{ external_link( ArchiveURL, arch_text, A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL'), nil ) .. ArchiveFormat, ArchiveDate } );
if not is_set(OriginalURL) then
Archived = Archived .. " " .. set_error('archive_missing_url');  
end
elseif is_set(OriginalURL) then -- DeadURL is empty, 'yes', 'true', 'y', 'unfit', 'usurped'
local arch_text = cfg.messages['archived-dead'];
if sepc ~= "." then arch_text = arch_text:lower() end
if in_array (DeadURL, {'unfit', 'usurped', 'bot: unknown'}) then
Archived = sepc .. " " .. 'Archived from the original on ' .. ArchiveDate; -- format already styled
if 'bot: unknown' == DeadURL then
add_maint_cat ('bot:_unknown'); -- and add a category if not already added
else
add_maint_cat ('unfit'); -- and add a category if not already added
end
else -- DeadURL is empty, 'yes', 'true', or 'y'
Archived = sepc .. " " .. substitute( arch_text,
{ external_link( OriginalURL, cfg.messages['original'], OriginalURLorigin, OriginalAccess ) .. OriginalFormat, ArchiveDate } ); -- format already styled
end
else
local arch_text = cfg.messages['archived-missing'];
if sepc ~= "." then arch_text = arch_text:lower() end
Archived = sepc .. " " .. substitute( arch_text,
{ set_error('archive_missing_url'), ArchiveDate } );
end
end
elseif is_set (ArchiveFormat) then
-- do we have |accessdate= without either |url= or |chapter-url=?
Archived = ArchiveFormat; -- if set and ArchiveURL not set ArchiveFormat has error message
if utilities.is_set (AccessDate) and not utilities.is_set (ChapterURL) then -- ChapterURL may be set when URL is not set;
else
utilities.set_message ('err_accessdate_missing_url');
Archived = ""
AccessDate = '';
end
local Lay = '';
if is_set(LayURL) then
if is_set(LayDate) then LayDate = " (" .. LayDate .. ")" end
if is_set(LaySource) then  
LaySource = " &ndash; ''" .. safe_for_italics(LaySource) .. "''";
else
LaySource = "";
end
end
if sepc == '.' then
Lay = sepc .. " " .. external_link( LayURL, cfg.messages['lay summary'], A:ORIGIN('LayURL'), nil ) .. LayFormat .. LaySource .. LayDate
else
Lay = sepc .. " " .. external_link( LayURL, cfg.messages['lay summary']:lower(), A:ORIGIN('LayURL'), nil ) .. LayFormat .. LaySource .. LayDate
end
elseif is_set (LayFormat) then -- Test if |lay-format= is given without giving a |lay-url=
Lay = sepc .. LayFormat; -- if set and LayURL not set, then LayFormat has error message
end
end


local UrlStatus = is_valid_parameter_value (A['UrlStatus'], A:ORIGIN('UrlStatus'), cfg.keywords_lists['url-status'], '');
if is_set(Transcript) then
local OriginalURL
if is_set(TranscriptURL) then
local OriginalURL_origin
Transcript = external_link( TranscriptURL, Transcript, TranscriptURLorigin, nil );
local OriginalFormat
end
local OriginalAccess;
Transcript = sepc .. ' ' .. Transcript .. TranscriptFormat;
UrlStatus = UrlStatus:lower(); -- used later when assembling archived text
elseif is_set(TranscriptURL) then
if utilities.is_set ( ArchiveURL ) then
Transcript = external_link( TranscriptURL, nil, TranscriptURLorigin, nil );
if utilities.is_set (ChapterURL) then -- if chapter-url= is set apply archive url to it
end
OriginalURL = ChapterURL; -- save copy of source chapter's url for archive text
OriginalURL_origin = ChapterURL_origin; -- name of |chapter-url= parameter for error messages
OriginalFormat = ChapterFormat; -- and original |chapter-format=


if 'live' ~= UrlStatus then
local Publisher;
ChapterURL = ArchiveURL -- swap-in the archive's URL
if is_set(PublicationDate) then
ChapterURL_origin = A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL') -- name of |archive-url= parameter for error messages
PublicationDate = wrap_msg ('published', PublicationDate);
ChapterFormat = ArchiveFormat or ''; -- swap in archive's format
end
ChapterUrlAccess = nil; -- restricted access levels do not make sense for archived URLs
if is_set(PublisherName) then
end
if is_set(PublicationPlace) then
elseif utilities.is_set (URL) then
Publisher = sepc .. " " .. PublicationPlace .. ": " .. PublisherName .. PublicationDate;
OriginalURL = URL; -- save copy of original source URL
else
OriginalURL_origin = URL_origin; -- name of URL parameter for error messages
Publisher = sepc .. " " .. PublisherName .. PublicationDate;
OriginalFormat = Format; -- and original |format=
end
OriginalAccess = UrlAccess;
elseif is_set(PublicationPlace) then  
Publisher= sepc .. " " .. PublicationPlace .. PublicationDate;
else
Publisher = PublicationDate;
end
-- Several of the above rely upon detecting this as nil, so do it last.
if is_set(Periodical) then
if is_set(Title) or is_set(TitleNote) then
Periodical = sepc .. " " .. wrap_style ('italic-title', Periodical)
else
Periodical = wrap_style ('italic-title', Periodical)
end
end


if 'live' ~= UrlStatus then -- if URL set then |archive-url= applies to it
--[[
URL = ArchiveURL -- swap-in the archive's URL
Handle the oddity that is cite speech.  This code overrides whatever may be the value assigned to TitleNote (through |department=) and forces it to be " (Speech)" so that
URL_origin = A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL') -- name of archive URL parameter for error messages
the annotation directly follows the |title= parameter value in the citation rather than the |event= parameter value (if provided).
Format = ArchiveFormat or ''; -- swap in archive's format
]]
UrlAccess = nil; -- restricted access levels do not make sense for archived URLs
if "speech" == config.CitationClass then -- cite speech only
TitleNote = " (Speech)"; -- annotate the citation
if is_set (Periodical) then -- if Periodical, perhaps because of an included |website= or |journal= parameter  
if is_set (Conference) then -- and if |event= is set
Conference = Conference .. sepc .. " "; -- then add appropriate punctuation to the end of the Conference variable before rendering
end
end
end
end
elseif utilities.is_set (UrlStatus) then -- if |url-status= is set when |archive-url= is not set
utilities.set_message ('maint_url_status'); -- add maint cat
end
end


if utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {'web', 'news', 'journal', 'magazine', 'pressrelease', 'podcast', 'newsgroup', 'arxiv', 'biorxiv', 'citeseerx', 'medrxiv', 'ssrn'}) or -- if any of the 'periodical' cites except encyclopedia
-- Piece all bits together at last. Here, all should be non-nil.
('citation' == config.CitationClass and (utilities.is_set (Periodical) or utilities.is_set (ScriptPeriodical)) and not utilities.is_set (Encyclopedia)) then
-- We build things this way because it is more efficient in LUA
local chap_param;
-- not to keep reassigning to the same string variable over and over.
if utilities.is_set (Chapter) then -- get a parameter name from one of these chapter related meta-parameters
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('Chapter')
elseif utilities.is_set (TransChapter) then
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('TransChapter')
elseif utilities.is_set (ChapterURL) then
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('ChapterURL')
elseif utilities.is_set (ScriptChapter) then
chap_param = ScriptChapter_origin;
else utilities.is_set (ChapterFormat)
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('ChapterFormat')
end


if utilities.is_set (chap_param) then -- if we found one
local tcommon;
utilities.set_message ('err_chapter_ignored', {chap_param}); -- add error message
local tcommon2; -- used for book cite when |contributor= is set
Chapter = ''; -- and set them to empty string to be safe with concatenation
TransChapter = '';
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"journal","citation"}) and is_set(Periodical) then
ChapterURL = '';
if is_set(Others) then Others = safe_join ({Others, sepc .. " "}, sepc) end -- add terminal punctuation & space; check for dup sepc; TODO why do we need to do this here?
ScriptChapter = '';
tcommon = safe_join( {Others, Title, TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Edition, Publisher, Agency, Volume}, sepc );
ChapterFormat = '';
elseif in_array(config.CitationClass, {"book","citation"}) and not is_set(Periodical) then -- special cases for book cites
end
if is_set (Contributors) then -- when we are citing foreword, preface, introduction, etc
else -- otherwise, format chapter / article title
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote}, sepc ); -- author and other stuff will come after this and before tcommon2
local no_quotes = false; -- default assume that we will be quoting the chapter parameter value
tcommon2 = safe_join( {Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Volume, Others, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
if utilities.is_set (Contribution) and 0 < #c then -- if this is a contribution with contributor(s)
else
if utilities.in_array (Contribution:lower(), cfg.keywords_lists.contribution) then -- and a generic contribution title
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Volume, Others, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
no_quotes = true; -- then render it unquoted
end
end
end


Chapter = format_chapter_title (ScriptChapter, ScriptChapter_origin, Chapter, Chapter_origin, TransChapter, TransChapter_origin, ChapterURL, ChapterURL_origin, no_quotes, ChapterUrlAccess); -- Contribution is also in Chapter
elseif 'map' == config.CitationClass then -- special cases for cite map
if utilities.is_set (Chapter) then
if is_set (Chapter) then -- map in a book; TitleType is part of Chapter
Chapter = Chapter .. ChapterFormat ;
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, Format, Edition, Scale, Series, Language, Cartography, Others, Publisher, Volume}, sepc );
if 'map' == config.CitationClass and utilities.is_set (TitleType) then
elseif is_set (Periodical) then -- map in a periodical
Chapter = Chapter .. ' ' .. TitleType; -- map annotation here; not after title
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleType, Format, Periodical, Scale, Series, Language, Cartography, Others, Publisher, Volume}, sepc );
end
else -- a sheet or stand-alone map
Chapter = Chapter .. sepc .. ' ';
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleType, Format, Edition, Scale, Series, Language, Cartography, Others, Publisher}, sepc );
elseif utilities.is_set (ChapterFormat) then -- |chapter= not set but |chapter-format= is so ...
Chapter = ChapterFormat .. sepc .. ' '; -- ... ChapterFormat has error message, we want to see it
end
end
end
elseif 'episode' == config.CitationClass then -- special case for cite episode
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote, TitleType, Series, Transcript, Language, Edition, Publisher}, sepc );


-- Format main title
else -- all other CS1 templates
local plain_title = false;
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language,  
local accept_title;
Volume, Others, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
Title, accept_title = utilities.has_accept_as_written (Title, true); -- remove accept-this-as-written markup when it wraps all of <Title>
if accept_title and ('' == Title) then -- only support forced empty for now "(())"
Title = cfg.messages['notitle']; -- replace by predefined "No title" message
-- TODO: utilities.set_message ( 'err_redundant_parameters', ...); -- issue proper error message instead of muting
ScriptTitle = ''; -- just mute for now
TransTitle = ''; -- just mute for now
plain_title = true; -- suppress text decoration for descriptive title
utilities.set_message ('maint_untitled'); -- add maint cat
end
end
 
if not accept_title then -- <Title> not wrapped in accept-as-written markup
if #ID_list > 0 then
if '...' == Title:sub (-3) then -- if ellipsis is the last three characters of |title=
ID_list = safe_join( { sepc .. " ", table.concat( ID_list, sepc .. " " ), ID }, sepc );
Title = Title:gsub ('(%.%.%.)%.+$', '%1'); -- limit the number of dots to three
elseif not mw.ustring.find (Title, '%.%s*%a%.$') and -- end of title is not a 'dot-(optional space-)letter-dot' initialism ...
not mw.ustring.find (Title, '%s+%a%.$') then -- ...and not a 'space-letter-dot' initial (''Allium canadense'' L.)
Title = mw.ustring.gsub(Title, '%' .. sepc .. '$', ''); -- remove any trailing separator character; sepc and ms.ustring() here for languages that use multibyte separator characters
end
 
if utilities.is_set (ArchiveURL) and is_archived_copy (Title) then
utilities.set_message ('maint_archived_copy'); -- add maintenance category before we modify the content of Title
end
 
if is_generic ('generic_titles', Title) then
utilities.set_message ('err_generic_title'); -- set an error message
end
end
 
if (not plain_title) and (utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {'web', 'news', 'journal', 'magazine', 'document', 'pressrelease', 'podcast', 'newsgroup', 'mailinglist', 'interview', 'arxiv', 'biorxiv', 'citeseerx', 'medrxiv', 'ssrn'}) or
('citation' == config.CitationClass and (utilities.is_set (Periodical) or utilities.is_set (ScriptPeriodical)) and not utilities.is_set (Encyclopedia)) or
('map' == config.CitationClass and (utilities.is_set (Periodical) or utilities.is_set (ScriptPeriodical)))) then -- special case for cite map when the map is in a periodical treat as an article
Title = kern_quotes (Title); -- if necessary, separate title's leading and trailing quote marks from module provided quote marks
Title = utilities.wrap_style ('quoted-title', Title);
Title = script_concatenate (Title, ScriptTitle, 'script-title'); -- <bdi> tags, lang attribute, categorization, etc.; must be done after title is wrapped
TransTitle = utilities.wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', TransTitle );
elseif plain_title or ('report' == config.CitationClass) then -- no styling for cite report and descriptive titles (otherwise same as above)
Title = script_concatenate (Title, ScriptTitle, 'script-title'); -- <bdi> tags, lang attribute, categorization, etc.; must be done after title is wrapped
TransTitle = utilities.wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', TransTitle ); -- for cite report, use this form for trans-title
else
else
Title = utilities.wrap_style ('italic-title', Title);
ID_list = ID;
Title = script_concatenate (Title, ScriptTitle, 'script-title'); -- <bdi> tags, lang attribute, categorization, etc.; must be done after title is wrapped
TransTitle = utilities.wrap_style ('trans-italic-title', TransTitle);
end
end
local idcommon = safe_join( { ID_list, URL, Archived, AccessDate, Via, SubscriptionRequired, Lay, Quote }, sepc );
local text;
local pgtext = Position .. Sheet .. Sheets .. Page .. Pages .. At;


if utilities.is_set (TransTitle) then
if is_set(Date) then
if utilities.is_set (Title) then
if is_set (Authors) or is_set (Editors) then -- date follows authors or editors when authors not set
TransTitle = " " .. TransTitle;
Date = " (" .. Date ..")" .. OrigYear .. sepc .. " "; -- in paranetheses
else
else -- neither of authors and editors set
utilities.set_message ('err_trans_missing_title', {'title'});
if (string.sub(tcommon,-1,-1) == sepc) then -- if the last character of tcommon is sepc
Date = " " .. Date .. OrigYear; -- Date does not begin with sepc
else
Date = sepc .. " " .. Date .. OrigYear; -- Date begins with sepc
end
end
end
end
end
 
if is_set(Authors) then
if utilities.is_set (Title) then -- TODO: is this the right place to be making Wikisource URLs?
if (not is_set (Date)) then -- when date is set it's in parentheses; no Authors termination
if utilities.is_set (TitleLink) and utilities.is_set (URL) then
Authors = terminate_name_list (Authors, sepc); -- when no date, terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
utilities.set_message ('err_wikilink_in_url'); -- set an error message because we can't have both
TitleLink = ''; -- unset
end
end
if is_set(Editors) then
if not utilities.is_set (TitleLink) and utilities.is_set (URL) then
local in_text = " ";
Title = external_link (URL, Title, URL_origin, UrlAccess) .. TransTitle .. Format;
local post_text = "";
URL = ''; -- unset these because no longer needed
if is_set(Chapter) and 0 == #c then
Format = "";
in_text = in_text .. cfg.messages['in'] .. " "
elseif utilities.is_set (TitleLink) and not utilities.is_set (URL) then
if (sepc ~= '.') then
local ws_url;
in_text = in_text:lower() -- lowercase for cs2
ws_url = wikisource_url_make (TitleLink); -- ignore ws_label return; not used here
end
if ws_url then
else
Title = external_link (ws_url, Title .. '&nbsp;', 'ws link in title-link'); -- space char after Title to move icon away from italic text; TODO: a better way to do this?
if EditorCount <= 1 then
Title = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['interwiki-icon'], {cfg.presentation['class-wikisource'], TitleLink, Title});
post_text = ", " .. cfg.messages['editor'];
Title = Title .. TransTitle;
else
post_text = ", " .. cfg.messages['editors'];
end
end
Editors = terminate_name_list (in_text .. Editors .. post_text, sepc); -- terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
end
if is_set (Contributors) then -- book cite and we're citing the intro, preface, etc
local by_text = sepc .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['by'] .. ' ';
if (sepc ~= '.') then by_text = by_text:lower() end -- lowercase for cs2
Authors = by_text .. Authors; -- author follows title so tweak it here
if is_set (Editors) and is_set (Date) then -- when Editors make sure that Authors gets terminated
Authors = terminate_name_list (Authors, sepc); -- terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
end
if (not is_set (Date)) then -- when date is set it's in parentheses; no Contributors termination
Contributors = terminate_name_list (Contributors, sepc); -- terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
end
text = safe_join( {Contributors, Date, Chapter, tcommon, Authors, Place, Editors, tcommon2, pgtext, idcommon }, sepc );
else
text = safe_join( {Authors, Date, Chapter, Place, Editors, tcommon, pgtext, idcommon }, sepc );
end
elseif is_set(Editors) then
if is_set(Date) then
if EditorCount <= 1 then
Editors = Editors .. ", " .. cfg.messages['editor'];
else
else
Title = utilities.make_wikilink (TitleLink, Title) .. TransTitle;
Editors = Editors .. ", " .. cfg.messages['editors'];
end
end
else
else
local ws_url, ws_label, L; -- Title has italic or quote markup by the time we get here which causes is_wikilink() to return 0 (not a wikilink)
if EditorCount <= 1 then
ws_url, ws_label, L = wikisource_url_make (Title:gsub('^[\'"]*(.-)[\'"]*$', '%1')); -- make ws URL from |title= interwiki link (strip italic or quote markup); link portion L becomes tooltip label
Editors = Editors .. " (" .. cfg.messages['editor'] .. ")" .. sepc .. " "
if ws_url then
Title = Title:gsub ('%b[]', ws_label); -- replace interwiki link with ws_label to retain markup
Title = external_link (ws_url, Title .. '&nbsp;', 'ws link in title'); -- space char after Title to move icon away from italic text; TODO: a better way to do this?
Title = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['interwiki-icon'], {cfg.presentation['class-wikisource'], L, Title});
Title = Title .. TransTitle;
else
else
Title = Title .. TransTitle;
Editors = Editors .. " (" .. cfg.messages['editors'] .. ")" .. sepc .. " "
end
end
end
end
text = safe_join( {Editors, Date, Chapter, Place, tcommon, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
else
else
Title = TransTitle;
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"journal","citation"}) and is_set(Periodical) then
text = safe_join( {Chapter, Place, tcommon, pgtext, Date, idcommon}, sepc );
else
text = safe_join( {Chapter, Place, tcommon, Date, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
end
end
end
if is_set(PostScript) and PostScript ~= sepc then
text = safe_join( {text, sepc}, sepc );  --Deals with italics, spaces, etc.
text = text:sub(1,-sepc:len()-1);
end
text = safe_join( {text, PostScript}, sepc );


if utilities.is_set (Place) then
-- Now enclose the whole thing in a <cite/> element
Place = " " .. wrap_msg ('written', Place, use_lowercase) .. sepc .. " ";
local options = {};
if is_set(config.CitationClass) and config.CitationClass ~= "citation" then
options.class = config.CitationClass;
options.class = "citation " .. config.CitationClass; -- class=citation required for blue highlight when used with |ref=
else
options.class = "citation";
end
end
if is_set(Ref) and Ref:lower() ~= "none" then -- set reference anchor if appropriate
local id = Ref
if ('harv' == Ref ) then
local namelist = {}; -- holds selected contributor, author, editor name list
local year = first_set ({Year, anchor_year}, 2); -- Year first for legacy citations and for YMD dates that require disambiguation


local ConferenceURL_origin = A:ORIGIN('ConferenceURL'); -- get name of parameter that holds ConferenceURL
if #c > 0 then -- if there is a contributor list
if utilities.is_set (Conference) then
namelist = c; -- select it
if utilities.is_set (ConferenceURL) then
elseif #a > 0 then -- or an author list
Conference = external_link( ConferenceURL, Conference, ConferenceURL_origin, nil );
namelist = a;
elseif #e > 0 then -- or an editor list
namelist = e;
end
if #namelist > 0 then -- if there are names in namelist
id = anchor_id (namelist, year); -- go make the CITEREF anchor
else
id = ''; -- unset
end
end
end
Conference = sepc .. " " .. Conference .. ConferenceFormat;
options.id = id;
elseif utilities.is_set (ConferenceURL) then
end
Conference = sepc .. " " .. external_link( ConferenceURL, nil, ConferenceURL_origin, nil );
if string.len(text:gsub("<span[^>/]*>(.-)</span>", "%1"):gsub("%b<>","")) <= 2 then -- remove <span> tags and other html-like markup; then get length of what remains
z.error_categories = {};
text = set_error('empty_citation');
z.message_tail = {};
end
end
local render = {}; -- here we collect the final bits for concatenation into the rendered citation
if is_set(options.id) then -- here we wrap the rendered citation in <cite ...>...</cite> tags
table.insert (render, substitute (cfg.presentation['cite-id'], {mw.uri.anchorEncode(options.id), mw.text.nowiki(options.class), text})); -- when |ref= is set
else
table.insert (render, substitute (cfg.presentation['cite'], {mw.text.nowiki(options.class), text})); -- all other cases
end


local Position = '';
table.insert (render, substitute (cfg.presentation['ocins'], {OCinSoutput})); -- append metadata to the citation
if not utilities.is_set (Position) then
local Minutes = A['Minutes'];
local Time = A['Time'];


if utilities.is_set (Minutes) then
if #z.message_tail ~= 0 then
if utilities.is_set (Time) then --TODO: make a function for this and similar?
table.insert (render, ' ');
utilities.set_message ('err_redundant_parameters', {utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', 'minutes') .. cfg.presentation['sep_list_pair'] .. utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', 'time')});
for i,v in ipairs( z.message_tail ) do
end
if is_set(v[1]) then
Position = " " .. Minutes .. " " .. cfg.messages['minutes'];
if i == #z.message_tail then
else
table.insert (render, error_comment( v[1], v[2] ));
if utilities.is_set (Time) then
else
local TimeCaption = A['TimeCaption']
table.insert (render, error_comment( v[1] .. "; ", v[2] ));
if not utilities.is_set (TimeCaption) then
TimeCaption = cfg.messages['event'];
if sepc ~= '.' then
TimeCaption = TimeCaption:lower();
end
end
end
Position = " " .. TimeCaption .. " " .. Time;
end
end
end
end
else
Position = " " .. Position;
At = '';
end
end


Page, Pages, Sheet, Sheets = format_pages_sheets (Page, Pages, Sheet, Sheets, config.CitationClass, Periodical_origin, sepc, NoPP, use_lowercase);
if #z.maintenance_cats ~= 0 then
 
table.insert (render, '<span class="citation-comment" style="display:none; color:#33aa33; margin-left:0.3em">');
At = utilities.is_set (At) and (sepc .. " " .. At) or "";
for _, v in ipairs( z.maintenance_cats ) do -- append maintenance categories
Position = utilities.is_set (Position) and (sepc .. " " .. Position) or "";
table.insert (render, v);
if config.CitationClass == 'map' then
table.insert (render, ' (');
local Sections = A['Sections']; -- Section (singular) is an alias of Chapter so set earlier
table.insert (render, make_wikilink (':Category:' .. v, 'link'));
local Inset = A['Inset'];
table.insert (render, ') ');
end
if utilities.is_set ( Inset ) then
table.insert (render, '</span>');
Inset = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('inset', Inset, use_lowercase);
end
end
 
no_tracking_cats = no_tracking_cats:lower();
if utilities.is_set ( Sections ) then
if in_array(no_tracking_cats, {"", "no", "false", "n"}) then
Section = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('sections', Sections, use_lowercase);
for _, v in ipairs( z.error_categories ) do
elseif utilities.is_set ( Section ) then
table.insert (render, make_wikilink ('Category:' .. v));
Section = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('section', Section, use_lowercase);
end
end
At = At .. Inset .. Section;
for _, v in ipairs( z.maintenance_cats ) do -- append maintenance categories
end
table.insert (render, make_wikilink ('Category:' .. v));
 
local Others = A['Others'];
if utilities.is_set (Others) and 0 == #a and 0 == #e then -- add maint cat when |others= has value and used without |author=, |editor=
if config.CitationClass == "AV-media-notes"
or config.CitationClass == "audio-visual" then -- special maint for AV/M which has a lot of 'false' positives right now
utilities.set_message ('maint_others_avm')
else
utilities.set_message ('maint_others');
end
end
end
for _, v in ipairs( z.properties_cats ) do -- append properties categories
Others = utilities.is_set (Others) and (sepc .. " " .. Others) or "";
table.insert (render, make_wikilink ('Category:' .. v));
if utilities.is_set (Translators) then
Others = safe_join ({sepc .. ' ', wrap_msg ('translated', Translators, use_lowercase), Others}, sepc);
end
if utilities.is_set (Interviewers) then
Others = safe_join ({sepc .. ' ', wrap_msg ('interview', Interviewers, use_lowercase), Others}, sepc);
end
local TitleNote = A['TitleNote'];
TitleNote = utilities.is_set (TitleNote) and (sepc .. " " .. TitleNote) or "";
if utilities.is_set (Edition) then
if Edition:match ('%f[%a][Ee]d%n?%.?$') or Edition:match ('%f[%a][Ee]dition$') then -- Ed, ed, Ed., ed., Edn, edn, Edn., edn.
utilities.set_message ('err_extra_text_edition'); -- add error message
end
end
Edition = " " .. wrap_msg ('edition', Edition);
else
Edition = '';
end
end


Series = utilities.is_set (Series) and wrap_msg ('series', {sepc, Series}) or ""; -- not the same as SeriesNum
return table.concat (render);
local Agency = A['Agency'];
end
Agency = utilities.is_set (Agency) and wrap_msg ('agency', {sepc, Agency}) or "";
Volume = format_volume_issue (Volume, Issue, ArticleNumber, config.CitationClass, Periodical_origin, sepc, use_lowercase);


if utilities.is_set (AccessDate) then
local retrv_text = " " .. cfg.messages['retrieved']


AccessDate = nowrap_date (AccessDate); -- wrap in nowrap span if date in appropriate format
--[[--------------------------< C S 1 . C I T A T I O N >------------------------------------------------------
if (sepc ~= ".") then retrv_text = retrv_text:lower() end -- if mode is cs2, lower case
AccessDate = utilities.substitute (retrv_text, AccessDate); -- add retrieved text


AccessDate = utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['accessdate'], {sepc, AccessDate}); -- allow editors to hide accessdates
This is used by templates such as {{cite book}} to create the actual citation text.
end
 
]]
 
function cs1.citation(frame)
Frame = frame; -- save a copy incase we need to display an error message in preview mode
local pframe = frame:getParent()
local validation, utilities, identifiers, metadata;
if utilities.is_set (ID) then ID = sepc .. " " .. ID; end
if nil ~= string.find (frame:getTitle(), 'sandbox', 1, true) then -- did the {{#invoke:}} use sandbox version?
cfg = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration/sandbox'); -- load sandbox versions of support modules
local Docket = A['Docket'];
whitelist = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Whitelist/sandbox');
  if "thesis" == config.CitationClass and utilities.is_set (Docket) then
utilities = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities/sandbox');
ID = sepc .. " Docket " .. Docket .. ID;
validation = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation/sandbox');
end
identifiers = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Identifiers/sandbox');
  if "report" == config.CitationClass and utilities.is_set (Docket) then -- for cite report when |docket= is set
metadata = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/COinS/sandbox');
ID = sepc .. ' ' .. Docket; -- overwrite ID even if |id= is set
else -- otherwise
cfg = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration'); -- load live versions of support modules
whitelist = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Whitelist');
utilities = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities');
validation = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation');
identifiers = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Identifiers');
metadata = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/COinS');
end
end


if utilities.is_set (URL) then
utilities.set_selected_modules (cfg); -- so that functions in Utilities can see the cfg tables
URL = " " .. external_link( URL, nil, URL_origin, UrlAccess );
identifiers.set_selected_modules (cfg, utilities); -- so that functions in Identifiers can see the selected cfg tables and selected Utilities module
end
validation.set_selected_modules (cfg, utilities); -- so that functions in Date validataion can see selected cfg tables and the selected Utilities module
metadata.set_selected_modules (cfg, utilities); -- so that functions in COinS can see the selected cfg tables and selected Utilities module
 
dates = validation.dates; -- imported functions from Module:Citation/CS1/Date validation
year_date_check = validation.year_date_check;
reformat_dates = validation.reformat_dates;
date_hyphen_to_dash = validation.date_hyphen_to_dash;
date_name_xlate = validation.date_name_xlate;
 
is_set = utilities.is_set; -- imported functions from Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
in_array = utilities.in_array;
substitute = utilities.substitute;
error_comment = utilities.error_comment;
set_error = utilities.set_error;
select_one = utilities.select_one;
add_maint_cat = utilities.add_maint_cat;
wrap_style = utilities.wrap_style;
safe_for_italics = utilities.safe_for_italics;
is_wikilink = utilities.is_wikilink;
make_wikilink = utilities.make_wikilink;


local Quote = A['Quote'];
z = utilities.z; -- table of error and category tables in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
local TransQuote = A['TransQuote'];
local ScriptQuote = A['ScriptQuote'];
if utilities.is_set (Quote) or utilities.is_set (TransQuote) or utilities.is_set (ScriptQuote) then


if utilities.is_set (Quote) then
extract_ids = identifiers.extract_ids; -- imported functions from Module:Citation/CS1/Identifiers
if Quote:sub(1, 1) == '"' and Quote:sub(-1, -1) == '"' then -- if first and last characters of quote are quote marks
build_id_list = identifiers.build_id_list;
Quote = Quote:sub(2, -2); -- strip them off
is_embargoed = identifiers.is_embargoed;
end
extract_id_access_levels = identifiers.extract_id_access_levels;
end
Quote = kern_quotes (Quote); -- kern if needed
Quote = utilities.wrap_style ('quoted-text', Quote ); -- wrap in <q>...</q> tags
if utilities.is_set (ScriptQuote) then
make_coins_title = metadata.make_coins_title; -- imported functions from Module:Citation/CS1/COinS
Quote = script_concatenate (Quote, ScriptQuote, 'script-quote'); -- <bdi> tags, lang attribute, categorization, etc.; must be done after quote is wrapped
get_coins_pages = metadata.get_coins_pages;
end
COinS = metadata.COinS;


if utilities.is_set (TransQuote) then
local args = {}; -- table where we store all of the template's arguments
if TransQuote:sub(1, 1) == '"' and TransQuote:sub(-1, -1) == '"' then -- if first and last characters of |trans-quote are quote marks
local suggestions = {}; -- table where we store suggestions if we need to loadData them
TransQuote = TransQuote:sub(2, -2); -- strip them off
local error_text, error_state;
end
Quote = Quote .. " " .. utilities.wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', TransQuote );
end


if utilities.is_set (QuotePage) or utilities.is_set (QuotePages) then -- add page prefix
local config = {}; -- table to store parameters from the module {{#invoke:}}
local quote_prefix = '';
for k, v in pairs( frame.args ) do
if utilities.is_set (QuotePage) then
config[k] = v;
extra_text_in_page_check (QuotePage, 'quote-page'); -- add to maint cat if |quote-page= value begins with what looks like p., pp., etc.
-- args[k] = v; -- debug tool that allows us to render a citation from module {{#invoke:}}
if not NoPP then
end
quote_prefix = utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['p-prefix'], {sepc, QuotePage}), '', '', '';
else
quote_prefix = utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['nopp'], {sepc, QuotePage}), '', '', '';
end
elseif utilities.is_set (QuotePages) then
extra_text_in_page_check (QuotePages, 'quote-pages'); -- add to maint cat if |quote-pages= value begins with what looks like p., pp., etc.
if tonumber(QuotePages) ~= nil and not NoPP then -- if only digits, assume single page
quote_prefix = utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['p-prefix'], {sepc, QuotePages}), '', '';
elseif not NoPP then
quote_prefix = utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['pp-prefix'], {sepc, QuotePages}), '', '';
else
quote_prefix = utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['nopp'], {sepc, QuotePages}), '', '';
end
end
                       
Quote = quote_prefix .. ": " .. Quote;
else
Quote = sepc .. " " .. Quote;
end


PostScript = ""; -- cs1|2 does not supply terminal punctuation when |quote= is set
local capture; -- the single supported capture when matching unknown parameters using patterns
end
for k, v in pairs( pframe.args ) do
if v ~= '' then
-- We check length of PostScript here because it will have been nuked by
if ('string' == type (k)) then
-- the quote parameters. We'd otherwise emit a message even if there wasn't
k = mw.ustring.gsub (k, '%d', cfg.date_names.local_digits); -- for enumerated parameters, translate 'local' digits to Western 0-9
-- a displayed postscript.
-- TODO: Should the max size (1) be configurable?
-- TODO: Should we check a specific pattern?
if utilities.is_set(PostScript) and mw.ustring.len(PostScript) > 1 then
utilities.set_message ('maint_postscript')
end
local Archived;
if utilities.is_set (ArchiveURL) then
if not utilities.is_set (ArchiveDate) then -- ArchiveURL set but ArchiveDate not set
utilities.set_message ('err_archive_missing_date'); -- emit an error message
ArchiveURL = ''; -- empty string for concatenation
ArchiveDate = ''; -- empty string for concatenation
end
else
if utilities.is_set (ArchiveDate) then -- ArchiveURL not set but ArchiveDate is set
utilities.set_message ('err_archive_date_missing_url'); -- emit an error message
ArchiveURL = ''; -- empty string for concatenation
ArchiveDate = ''; -- empty string for concatenation
end
end
 
if utilities.is_set (ArchiveURL) then
local arch_text;
-- if not utilities.is_set (ArchiveDate) then
-- utilities.set_message ('err_archive_missing_date');
-- ArchiveDate = ''; -- empty string for concatenation
-- end
if "live" == UrlStatus then
arch_text = cfg.messages['archived'];
if sepc ~= "." then arch_text = arch_text:lower() end
if utilities.is_set (ArchiveDate) then
Archived = sepc .. ' ' .. utilities.substitute ( cfg.messages['archived-live'],
{external_link( ArchiveURL, arch_text, A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL'), nil) .. ArchiveFormat, ArchiveDate } );
else
Archived = '';
end
end
if not utilities.is_set (OriginalURL) then
if not validate( k, config.CitationClass ) then
utilities.set_message ('err_archive_missing_url');
error_text = "";
Archived = ''; -- empty string for concatenation
if type( k ) ~= 'string' then
end
-- Exclude empty numbered parameters
elseif utilities.is_set (OriginalURL) then -- UrlStatus is empty, 'dead', 'unfit', 'usurped', 'bot: unknown'
if v:match("%S+") ~= nil then
if utilities.in_array (UrlStatus, {'unfit', 'usurped', 'bot: unknown'}) then
error_text, error_state = set_error( 'text_ignored', {v}, true );
arch_text = cfg.messages['archived-unfit'];
end
if sepc ~= "." then arch_text = arch_text:lower() end
elseif validate( k:lower(), config.CitationClass ) then  
Archived = sepc .. ' ' .. arch_text .. ArchiveDate; -- format already styled
error_text, error_state = set_error( 'parameter_ignored_suggest', {k, k:lower()}, true );
if 'bot: unknown' == UrlStatus then
utilities.set_message ('maint_bot_unknown'); -- and add a category if not already added
else
else
utilities.set_message ('maint_unfit'); -- and add a category if not already added
if nil == suggestions.suggestions then -- if this table is nil then we need to load it
end
if nil ~= string.find (frame:getTitle(), 'sandbox', 1, true) then -- did the {{#invoke:}} use sandbox version?
else -- UrlStatus is empty, 'dead'
suggestions = mw.loadData( 'Module:Citation/CS1/Suggestions/sandbox' ); -- use the sandbox version
arch_text = cfg.messages['archived-dead'];
else
if sepc ~= "." then arch_text = arch_text:lower() end
suggestions = mw.loadData( 'Module:Citation/CS1/Suggestions' ); -- use the live version
if utilities.is_set (ArchiveDate) then
end
Archived = sepc .. " " .. utilities.substitute ( arch_text,
end
{ external_link( OriginalURL, cfg.messages['original'], OriginalURL_origin, OriginalAccess ) .. OriginalFormat, ArchiveDate } ); -- format already styled
for pattern, param in pairs (suggestions.patterns) do -- loop through the patterns to see if we can suggest a proper parameter
else
capture = k:match (pattern); -- the whole match if no caputre in pattern else the capture if a match
Archived = ''; -- unset for concatenation
if capture then -- if the pattern matches
end
param = substitute( param, capture ); -- add the capture to the suggested parameter (typically the enumerator)
end
error_text, error_state = set_error( 'parameter_ignored_suggest', {k, param}, true ); -- set the error message
else -- OriginalUrl not set
end
utilities.set_message ('err_archive_missing_url');
end
Archived = ''; -- empty string for concatenation
if not is_set (error_text) then -- couldn't match with a pattern, is there an expicit suggestion?
end
if suggestions.suggestions[ k:lower() ] ~= nil then
elseif utilities.is_set (ArchiveFormat) then
error_text, error_state = set_error( 'parameter_ignored_suggest', {k, suggestions.suggestions[ k:lower() ]}, true );
Archived = ArchiveFormat; -- if set and ArchiveURL not set ArchiveFormat has error message
else
else
error_text, error_state = set_error( 'parameter_ignored', {k}, true );
Archived = '';
v = ''; -- unset value assigned to unrecognized parameters (this for the limited parameter lists)
end
end
end
-- local Lay = '';
end  
-- local LaySource = A['LaySource'];
if error_text ~= '' then
-- local LayURL = A['LayURL'];
table.insert( z.message_tail, {error_text, error_state} );
-- local LayFormat = A['LayFormat'];
end
-- LayFormat = style_format (LayFormat, LayURL, 'lay-format', 'lay-url');
-- if utilities.is_set (LayURL) then
-- if utilities.is_set (LayDate) then LayDate = " (" .. LayDate .. ")" end
-- if utilities.is_set (LaySource) then
-- LaySource = " &ndash; ''" .. utilities.safe_for_italics (LaySource) .. "''";
-- else
-- LaySource = "";
-- end
-- if sepc == '.' then
-- Lay = sepc .. " " .. external_link( LayURL, cfg.messages['lay summary'], A:ORIGIN('LayURL'), nil ) .. LayFormat .. LaySource .. LayDate
-- else
-- Lay = sepc .. " " .. external_link( LayURL, cfg.messages['lay summary']:lower(), A:ORIGIN('LayURL'), nil ) .. LayFormat .. LaySource .. LayDate
-- end
-- elseif utilities.is_set (LayFormat) then -- Test if |lay-format= is given without giving a |lay-url=
-- Lay = sepc .. LayFormat; -- if set and LayURL not set, then LayFormat has error message
-- end
 
local TranscriptURL = A['TranscriptURL']
local TranscriptFormat = A['TranscriptFormat'];
TranscriptFormat = style_format (TranscriptFormat, TranscriptURL, 'transcript-format', 'transcripturl');
local Transcript = A['Transcript'];
local TranscriptURL_origin = A:ORIGIN('TranscriptURL'); -- get name of parameter that holds TranscriptURL
if utilities.is_set (Transcript) then
if utilities.is_set (TranscriptURL) then
Transcript = external_link( TranscriptURL, Transcript, TranscriptURL_origin, nil );
end
Transcript = sepc .. ' ' .. Transcript .. TranscriptFormat;
elseif utilities.is_set (TranscriptURL) then
Transcript = external_link( TranscriptURL, nil, TranscriptURL_origin, nil );
end
 
local Publisher;
if utilities.is_set (PublicationDate) then
PublicationDate = wrap_msg ('published', PublicationDate);
end
if utilities.is_set (PublisherName) then
if utilities.is_set (PublicationPlace) then
Publisher = sepc .. " " .. PublicationPlace .. ": " .. PublisherName .. PublicationDate;
else
Publisher = sepc .. " " .. PublisherName .. PublicationDate; 
end
elseif utilities.is_set (PublicationPlace) then
Publisher= sepc .. " " .. PublicationPlace .. PublicationDate;
else
Publisher = PublicationDate;
end
-- Several of the above rely upon detecting this as nil, so do it last.
if (utilities.is_set (Periodical) or utilities.is_set (ScriptPeriodical) or utilities.is_set (TransPeriodical)) then
if utilities.is_set (Title) or utilities.is_set (TitleNote) then
Periodical = sepc .. " " .. format_periodical (ScriptPeriodical, ScriptPeriodical_origin, Periodical, TransPeriodical, TransPeriodical_origin);
else  
Periodical = format_periodical (ScriptPeriodical, ScriptPeriodical_origin, Periodical, TransPeriodical, TransPeriodical_origin);
end
end
local Language = A['Language'];
if utilities.is_set (Language) then
Language = language_parameter (Language); -- format, categories, name from ISO639-1, etc.
else
Language=''; -- language not specified so make sure this is an empty string;
--[[ TODO: need to extract the wrap_msg from language_parameter
so that we can solve parentheses bunching problem with Format/Language/TitleType
]]
end
 
--[[
Handle the oddity that is cite speech.  This code overrides whatever may be the value assigned to TitleNote (through |department=) and forces it to be " (Speech)" so that
the annotation directly follows the |title= parameter value in the citation rather than the |event= parameter value (if provided).
]]
if "speech" == config.CitationClass then -- cite speech only
TitleNote = TitleType; -- move TitleType to TitleNote so that it renders ahead of |event=
TitleType = ''; -- and unset
 
if utilities.is_set (Periodical) then -- if Periodical, perhaps because of an included |website= or |journal= parameter
if utilities.is_set (Conference) then -- and if |event= is set
Conference = Conference .. sepc .. " "; -- then add appropriate punctuation to the end of the Conference variable before rendering
end
end
end
missing_pipe_check (v); -- do we think that there is a parameter that is missing a pipe?
end
-- TODO: is this the best place for this translation?
 
args[k] = v;
-- Piece all bits together at last.  Here, all should be non-nil.
elseif args[k] ~= nil or (k == 'postscript') then -- here when v is empty string
-- We build things this way because it is more efficient in LUA
args[k] = v; -- why do we do this? we don't support 'empty' parameters
-- not to keep reassigning to the same string variable over and over.
end
 
local tcommon;
local tcommon2; -- used for book cite when |contributor= is set
if utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {"journal", "citation"}) and utilities.is_set (Periodical) then
if not (utilities.is_set (Authors) or utilities.is_set (Editors)) then
Others = Others:gsub ('^' .. sepc .. ' ', ''); -- when no authors and no editors, strip leading sepc and space
end
if utilities.is_set (Others) then Others = safe_join ({Others, sepc .. " "}, sepc) end -- add terminal punctuation & space; check for dup sepc; TODO why do we need to do this here?
tcommon = safe_join( {Others, Title, TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Edition, Publisher, Agency, Volume}, sepc );
elseif utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {"book", "citation"}) and not utilities.is_set (Periodical) then -- special cases for book cites
if utilities.is_set (Contributors) then -- when we are citing foreword, preface, introduction, etc.
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote}, sepc ); -- author and other stuff will come after this and before tcommon2
tcommon2 = safe_join( {Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Volume, Others, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
else
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Volume, Others, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
end
 
elseif 'map' == config.CitationClass then -- special cases for cite map
if utilities.is_set (Chapter) then -- map in a book; TitleType is part of Chapter
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, Format, Edition, Scale, Series, Language, Cartography, Others, Publisher, Volume}, sepc );
elseif utilities.is_set (Periodical) then -- map in a periodical
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleType, Format, Periodical, Scale, Series, Language, Cartography, Others, Publisher, Volume}, sepc );
else -- a sheet or stand-alone map
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleType, Format, Edition, Scale, Series, Language, Cartography, Others, Publisher}, sepc );
end
elseif 'episode' == config.CitationClass then -- special case for cite episode
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote, TitleType, Series, Language, Edition, Publisher}, sepc );
 
else -- all other CS1 templates
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language,
Volume, Others, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
end
if #ID_list > 0 then
ID_list = safe_join( { sepc .. " ",  table.concat( ID_list, sepc .. " " ), ID }, sepc );
else
ID_list = ID;
end
local Via = A['Via'];
Via = utilities.is_set (Via) and  wrap_msg ('via', Via) or '';
local idcommon;
if 'audio-visual' == config.CitationClass or 'episode' == config.CitationClass then -- special case for cite AV media & cite episode position transcript
-- idcommon = safe_join( { ID_list, URL, Archived, Transcript, AccessDate, Via, Lay, Quote }, sepc );
idcommon = safe_join( { ID_list, URL, Archived, Transcript, AccessDate, Via, Quote }, sepc );
else
-- idcommon = safe_join( { ID_list, URL, Archived, AccessDate, Via, Lay, Quote }, sepc );
idcommon = safe_join( { ID_list, URL, Archived, AccessDate, Via, Quote }, sepc );
end
local text;
local pgtext = Position .. Sheet .. Sheets .. Page .. Pages .. At;
 
local OrigDate = A['OrigDate'];
OrigDate = utilities.is_set (OrigDate) and wrap_msg ('origdate', OrigDate) or '';
if utilities.is_set (Date) then
if utilities.is_set (Authors) or utilities.is_set (Editors) then -- date follows authors or editors when authors not set
Date = " (" .. Date .. ")" .. OrigDate .. sepc .. " "; -- in parentheses
else -- neither of authors and editors set
if (string.sub(tcommon, -1, -1) == sepc) then -- if the last character of tcommon is sepc
Date = " " .. Date .. OrigDate; -- Date does not begin with sepc
else
Date = sepc .. " " .. Date .. OrigDate; -- Date begins with sepc
end
end
end
if utilities.is_set (Authors) then
if (not utilities.is_set (Date)) then -- when date is set it's in parentheses; no Authors termination
Authors = terminate_name_list (Authors, sepc); -- when no date, terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
end
if utilities.is_set (Editors) then
local in_text = '';
local post_text = '';
if utilities.is_set (Chapter) and 0 == #c then
in_text = cfg.messages['in'] .. ' ';
if (sepc ~= '.') then
in_text = in_text:lower(); -- lowercase for cs2
end
end
if EditorCount <= 1 then
post_text = ' (' .. cfg.messages['editor'] .. ')'; -- be consistent with no-author, no-date case
else
post_text = ' (' .. cfg.messages['editors'] .. ')';
end
Editors = terminate_name_list (in_text .. Editors .. post_text, sepc); -- terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
end
if utilities.is_set (Contributors) then -- book cite and we're citing the intro, preface, etc.
local by_text = sepc .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['by'] .. ' ';
if (sepc ~= '.') then by_text = by_text:lower() end -- lowercase for cs2
Authors = by_text .. Authors; -- author follows title so tweak it here
if utilities.is_set (Editors) and utilities.is_set (Date) then -- when Editors make sure that Authors gets terminated
Authors = terminate_name_list (Authors, sepc); -- terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
end
if (not utilities.is_set (Date)) then -- when date is set it's in parentheses; no Contributors termination
Contributors = terminate_name_list (Contributors, sepc); -- terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
end
text = safe_join( {Contributors, Date, Chapter, tcommon, Authors, Place, Editors, tcommon2, pgtext, idcommon }, sepc );
else
text = safe_join( {Authors, Date, Chapter, Place, Editors, tcommon, pgtext, idcommon }, sepc );
end
elseif utilities.is_set (Editors) then
if utilities.is_set (Date) then
if EditorCount <= 1 then
Editors = Editors .. cfg.presentation['sep_name'] .. cfg.messages['editor'];
else
Editors = Editors .. cfg.presentation['sep_name'] .. cfg.messages['editors'];
end
else
if EditorCount <= 1 then
Editors = Editors .. " (" .. cfg.messages['editor'] .. ")" .. sepc .. " "
else
Editors = Editors .. " (" .. cfg.messages['editors'] .. ")" .. sepc .. " "
end
end
text = safe_join( {Editors, Date, Chapter, Place, tcommon, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
else
if utilities.in_array (config.CitationClass, {"journal", "citation"}) and utilities.is_set (Periodical) then
text = safe_join( {Chapter, Place, tcommon, pgtext, Date, idcommon}, sepc );
else
text = safe_join( {Chapter, Place, tcommon, Date, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
end
end
if utilities.is_set (PostScript) and PostScript ~= sepc then
text = safe_join( {text, sepc}, sepc ); -- Deals with italics, spaces, etc.
text = text:sub(1, -sepc:len() - 1);
end
text = safe_join( {text, PostScript}, sepc );
 
-- Now enclose the whole thing in a <cite> element
local options_t = {};
options_t.class = cite_class_attribute_make (config.CitationClass, Mode);
 
local Ref = is_valid_parameter_value (A['Ref'], A:ORIGIN('Ref'), cfg.keywords_lists['ref'], nil, true); -- nil when |ref=harv; A['Ref'] else
 
if 'none' ~= cfg.keywords_xlate[(Ref and Ref:lower()) or ''] then
local namelist_t = {}; -- holds selected contributor, author, editor name list
local year = first_set ({Year, anchor_year}, 2); -- Year first for legacy citations and for YMD dates that require disambiguation
 
if #c > 0 then -- if there is a contributor list
namelist_t = c; -- select it
elseif #a > 0 then -- or an author list
namelist_t = a;
elseif #e > 0 then -- or an editor list
namelist_t = e;
end
local citeref_id;
if #namelist_t > 0 then -- if there are names in namelist_t
citeref_id = make_citeref_id (namelist_t, year); -- go make the CITEREF anchor
if mw.uri.anchorEncode (citeref_id) == ((Ref and mw.uri.anchorEncode (Ref)) or '') then -- Ref may already be encoded (by {{sfnref}}) so citeref_id must be encoded before comparison
utilities.set_message ('maint_ref_duplicates_default');
end
else
citeref_id = ''; -- unset
end
options_t.id = Ref or citeref_id;
end
 
if string.len (text:gsub('%b<>', '')) <= 2 then -- remove html and html-like tags; then get length of what remains;
z.error_cats_t = {}; -- blank the categories list
z.error_msgs_t = {}; -- blank the error messages list
OCinSoutput = nil; -- blank the metadata string
text = ''; -- blank the the citation
utilities.set_message ('err_empty_citation'); -- set empty citation message and category
end
local render_t = {}; -- here we collect the final bits for concatenation into the rendered citation
 
if utilities.is_set (options_t.id) then -- here we wrap the rendered citation in <cite ...>...</cite> tags
table.insert (render_t, utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['cite-id'], {mw.uri.anchorEncode(options_t.id), mw.text.nowiki(options_t.class), text})); -- when |ref= is set or when there is a namelist
else
table.insert (render_t, utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['cite'], {mw.text.nowiki(options_t.class), text})); -- when |ref=none or when namelist_t empty and |ref= is missing or is empty
end
 
if OCinSoutput then -- blanked when citation is 'empty' so don't bother to add boilerplate metadata span
table.insert (render_t, utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['ocins'], OCinSoutput)); -- format and append metadata to the citation
end
 
local template_name = ('citation' == config.CitationClass) and 'citation' or 'cite ' .. (cfg.citation_class_map_t[config.CitationClass] or config.CitationClass);
local template_link = '[[Template:' .. template_name .. '|' .. template_name .. ']]';
local msg_prefix = '<code class="cs1-code">{{' .. template_link .. '}}</code>: ';
 
if 0 ~= #z.error_msgs_t then
mw.addWarning (utilities.substitute (cfg.messages.warning_msg_e, template_link));
 
table.insert (render_t, ' '); -- insert a space between citation and its error messages
table.sort (z.error_msgs_t); -- sort the error messages list; sorting includes wrapping <span> and <code> tags; hidden-error sorts ahead of visible-error
 
local hidden = true; -- presume that the only error messages emited by this template are hidden
for _, v in ipairs (z.error_msgs_t) do -- spin through the list of error messages
if v:find ('cs1-visible-error', 1, true) then -- look for the visible error class name
hidden = false; -- found one; so don't hide the error message prefix
break; -- and done because no need to look further
end
end
 
z.error_msgs_t[1] = table.concat ({utilities.error_comment (msg_prefix, hidden), z.error_msgs_t[1]}); -- add error message prefix to first error message to prevent extraneous punctuation
table.insert (render_t, table.concat (z.error_msgs_t, '; ')); -- make a big string of error messages and add it to the rendering
end
 
if 0 ~= #z.maint_cats_t then
mw.addWarning (utilities.substitute (cfg.messages.warning_msg_m, template_link));
 
table.sort (z.maint_cats_t); -- sort the maintenance messages list
 
local maint_msgs_t = {}; -- here we collect all of the maint messages
 
if 0 == #z.error_msgs_t then -- if no error messages
table.insert (maint_msgs_t, msg_prefix); -- insert message prefix in maint message livery
end
for _, v in ipairs( z.maint_cats_t ) do -- append maintenance categories
table.insert (maint_msgs_t, -- assemble new maint message and add it to the maint_msgs_t table
table.concat ({v, ' (', utilities.substitute (cfg.messages[':cat wikilink'], v), ')'})
);
end
table.insert (render_t, utilities.substitute (cfg.presentation['hidden-maint'], table.concat (maint_msgs_t, ' '))); -- wrap the group of maint messages with proper presentation and save
end
 
if not no_tracking_cats then
for _, v in ipairs (z.error_cats_t) do -- append error categories
table.insert (render_t, utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['cat wikilink'], v));
end
for _, v in ipairs (z.maint_cats_t) do -- append maintenance categories
table.insert (render_t, utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['cat wikilink'], v));
end
for _, v in ipairs (z.prop_cats_t) do -- append properties categories
table.insert (render_t, utilities.substitute (cfg.messages['cat wikilink'], v));
end
end
 
return table.concat (render_t); -- make a big string and done
end
 
 
--[[--------------------------< V A L I D A T E >--------------------------------------------------------------
 
Looks for a parameter's name in one of several whitelists.
 
Parameters in the whitelist can have three values:
true - active, supported parameters
false - deprecated, supported parameters
nil - unsupported parameters
]]
 
local function validate (name, cite_class, empty)
local name = tostring (name);
local enum_name; -- parameter name with enumerator (if any) replaced with '#'
local state;
local function state_test (state, name) -- local function to do testing of state values
if true == state then return true; end -- valid actively supported parameter
if false == state then
if empty then return nil; end -- empty deprecated parameters are treated as unknowns
deprecated_parameter (name); -- parameter is deprecated but still supported
return true;
end
if 'tracked' == state then
local base_name = name:gsub ('%d', ''); -- strip enumerators from parameter names that have them to get the base name
utilities.add_prop_cat ('tracked-param', {base_name}, base_name); -- add a properties category; <base_name> modifies <key>
return true;
end
return nil;
end
 
if name:find ('#') then -- # is a cs1|2 reserved character so parameters with # not permitted
return nil;
end
-- replace wnumerator digit(s) with # (|last25= becomes |last#=) (mw.ustring because non-Western 'local' digits)
enum_name = mw.ustring.gsub (name, '%d+$', '#'); -- where enumerator is last charaters in parameter name (these to protect |s2cid=)
enum_name = mw.ustring.gsub (enum_name, '%d+([%-l])', '#%1'); -- where enumerator is in the middle of the parameter name; |author#link= is the oddity
 
if 'document' == cite_class then -- special case for {{cite document}}
state = whitelist.document_parameters_t[enum_name]; -- this list holds enumerated and nonenumerated parameters
if true == state_test (state, name) then return true; end
return false;
end
 
if utilities.in_array (cite_class, whitelist.preprint_template_list_t) then -- limited parameter sets allowed for these templates
state = whitelist.limited_parameters_t[enum_name]; -- this list holds enumerated and nonenumerated parameters
if true == state_test (state, name) then return true; end
 
state = whitelist.preprint_arguments_t[cite_class][name]; -- look in the parameter-list for the template identified by cite_class
if true == state_test (state, name) then return true; end
 
return false; -- not supported because not found or name is set to nil
end -- end limited parameter-set templates
 
if utilities.in_array (cite_class, whitelist.unique_param_template_list_t) then -- template-specific parameters for templates that accept parameters from the basic argument list
state = whitelist.unique_arguments_t[cite_class][name]; -- look in the template-specific parameter-lists for the template identified by cite_class
if true == state_test (state, name) then return true; end
end -- if here, fall into general validation
 
state = whitelist.common_parameters_t[enum_name]; -- all other templates; all normal parameters allowed; this list holds enumerated and nonenumerated parameters
if true == state_test (state, name) then return true; end
 
return false; -- not supported because not found or name is set to nil
end
 
 
--[=[-------------------------< I N T E R _ W I K I _ C H E C K >----------------------------------------------
 
check <value> for inter-language interwiki-link markup.  <prefix> must be a MediaWiki-recognized language
code.  when these values have the form (without leading colon):
[[<prefix>:link|label]] return label as plain-text
[[<prefix>:link]] return <prefix>:link as plain-text
 
return value as is else
 
]=]
 
local function inter_wiki_check (parameter, value)
local prefix = value:match ('%[%[(%a+):'); -- get an interwiki prefix if one exists
local _;
if prefix and cfg.inter_wiki_map[prefix:lower()] then -- if prefix is in the map, needs preceding colon so
utilities.set_message ('err_bad_paramlink', parameter); -- emit an error message
_, value, _ = utilities.is_wikilink (value); -- extract label portion from wikilink
end
return value;
end
 
 
--[[--------------------------< M I S S I N G _ P I P E _ C H E C K >------------------------------------------
 
Look at the contents of a parameter. If the content has a string of characters and digits followed by an equal
sign, compare the alphanumeric string to the list of cs1|2 parameters.  If found, then the string is possibly a
parameter that is missing its pipe.  There are two tests made:
{{cite ... |title=Title access-date=2016-03-17}} -- the first parameter has a value and whitespace separates that value from the missing pipe parameter name
{{cite ... |title=access-date=2016-03-17}} -- the first parameter has no value (whitespace after the first = is trimmed by MediaWiki)
cs1|2 shares some parameter names with XML/HTML attributes: class=, title=, etc.  To prevent false positives XML/HTML
tags are removed before the search.
 
If a missing pipe is detected, this function adds the missing pipe maintenance category.
 
]]
 
local function missing_pipe_check (parameter, value)
local capture;
value = value:gsub ('%b<>', ''); -- remove XML/HTML tags because attributes: class=, title=, etc.
 
capture = value:match ('%s+(%a[%w%-]+)%s*=') or value:match ('^(%a[%w%-]+)%s*='); -- find and categorize parameters with possible missing pipes
if capture and validate (capture) then -- if the capture is a valid parameter name
utilities.set_message ('err_missing_pipe', parameter);
end
end
 
 
--[[--------------------------< H A S _ E X T R A N E O U S _ P U N C T >--------------------------------------
 
look for extraneous terminal punctuation in most parameter values; parameters listed in skip table are not checked
 
]]
 
local function has_extraneous_punc (param, value)
if 'number' == type (param) then
return;
end
param = param:gsub ('%d+', '#'); -- enumerated name-list mask params allow terminal punct; normalize
if cfg.punct_skip[param] then
return; -- parameter name found in the skip table so done
end
if value:match ('[,;:]$') then
utilities.set_message ('maint_extra_punct'); -- has extraneous punctuation; add maint cat
end
if value:match ('^=') then -- sometimes an extraneous '=' character appears ...
utilities.set_message ('maint_extra_punct'); -- has extraneous punctuation; add maint cat
end
end
 
 
--[[--------------------------< H A S _ E X T R A N E O U S _ U R L >------------------------------------------
 
look for extraneous url parameter values; parameters listed in skip table are not checked
 
]]
 
local function has_extraneous_url (url_param_t)
local url_error_t = {};
check_for_url (url_param_t, url_error_t); -- extraneous url check
if 0 ~= #url_error_t then -- non-zero when there are errors
table.sort (url_error_t);
utilities.set_message ('err_param_has_ext_link', {utilities.make_sep_list (#url_error_t, url_error_t)}); -- add this error message
end
end
 
 
--[[--------------------------< C I T A T I O N >--------------------------------------------------------------
 
This is used by templates such as {{cite book}} to create the actual citation text.
 
]]
 
local function citation(frame)
Frame = frame; -- save a copy in case we need to display an error message in preview mode
 
local config = {}; -- table to store parameters from the module {{#invoke:}}
for k, v in pairs( frame.args ) do -- get parameters from the {{#invoke}} frame
config[k] = v;
-- args[k] = v; -- crude debug support that allows us to render a citation from module {{#invoke:}}; skips parameter validation; TODO: keep?
end
-- i18n: set the name that your wiki uses to identify sandbox subpages from sandbox template invoke (or can be set here)
local sandbox = ((config.SandboxPath and '' ~= config.SandboxPath) and config.SandboxPath) or '/sandbox'; -- sandbox path from {{#invoke:Citation/CS1/sandbox|citation|SandboxPath=/...}}
is_sandbox = nil ~= string.find (frame:getTitle(), sandbox, 1, true); -- is this invoke the sandbox module?
sandbox = is_sandbox and sandbox or ''; -- use i18n sandbox to load sandbox modules when this module is the sandox; live modules else
 
local pframe = frame:getParent()
local styles;
cfg = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration' .. sandbox); -- load sandbox versions of support modules when {{#invoke:Citation/CS1/sandbox|...}}; live modules else
whitelist = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Whitelist' .. sandbox);
utilities = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities' .. sandbox);
validation = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation' .. sandbox);
identifiers = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Identifiers' .. sandbox);
metadata = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/COinS' .. sandbox);
styles = 'Module:Citation/CS1' .. sandbox .. '/styles.css';
 
utilities.set_selected_modules (cfg); -- so that functions in Utilities can see the selected cfg tables
identifiers.set_selected_modules (cfg, utilities); -- so that functions in Identifiers can see the selected cfg tables and selected Utilities module
validation.set_selected_modules (cfg, utilities); -- so that functions in Date validataion can see selected cfg tables and the selected Utilities module
metadata.set_selected_modules (cfg, utilities); -- so that functions in COinS can see the selected cfg tables and selected Utilities module
 
z = utilities.z; -- table of error and category tables in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
 
is_preview_mode = not utilities.is_set (frame:preprocess ('{{REVISIONID}}'));
 
local args = {}; -- table where we store all of the template's arguments
local suggestions = {}; -- table where we store suggestions if we need to loadData them
local error_text; -- used as a flag
 
local capture; -- the single supported capture when matching unknown parameters using patterns
local empty_unknowns = {}; -- sequence table to hold empty unknown params for error message listing
for k, v in pairs( pframe.args ) do -- get parameters from the parent (template) frame
v = mw.ustring.gsub (v, '^%s*(.-)%s*$', '%1'); -- trim leading/trailing whitespace; when v is only whitespace, becomes empty string
if v ~= '' then
if ('string' == type (k)) then
k = mw.ustring.gsub (k, '%d', cfg.date_names.local_digits); -- for enumerated parameters, translate 'local' digits to Western 0-9
end
if not validate( k, config.CitationClass ) then
if type (k) ~= 'string' then -- exclude empty numbered parameters
if v:match("%S+") ~= nil then
error_text = utilities.set_message ('err_text_ignored', {v});
end
elseif validate (k:lower(), config.CitationClass) then
error_text = utilities.set_message ('err_parameter_ignored_suggest', {k, k:lower()}); -- suggest the lowercase version of the parameter
else
if nil == suggestions.suggestions then -- if this table is nil then we need to load it
suggestions = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Suggestions' .. sandbox); --load sandbox version of suggestion module when {{#invoke:Citation/CS1/sandbox|...}}; live module else
end
for pattern, param in pairs (suggestions.patterns) do -- loop through the patterns to see if we can suggest a proper parameter
capture = k:match (pattern); -- the whole match if no capture in pattern else the capture if a match
if capture then -- if the pattern matches
param = utilities.substitute (param, capture); -- add the capture to the suggested parameter (typically the enumerator)
if validate (param, config.CitationClass) then -- validate the suggestion to make sure that the suggestion is supported by this template (necessary for limited parameter lists)
error_text = utilities.set_message ('err_parameter_ignored_suggest', {k, param}); -- set the suggestion error message
else
error_text = utilities.set_message ('err_parameter_ignored', {k}); -- suggested param not supported by this template
v = ''; -- unset
end
end
end
if not utilities.is_set (error_text) then -- couldn't match with a pattern, is there an explicit suggestion?
if (suggestions.suggestions[ k:lower() ] ~= nil) and validate (suggestions.suggestions[ k:lower() ], config.CitationClass) then
utilities.set_message ('err_parameter_ignored_suggest', {k, suggestions.suggestions[ k:lower() ]});
else
utilities.set_message ('err_parameter_ignored', {k});
v = ''; -- unset value assigned to unrecognized parameters (this for the limited parameter lists)
end
end
end  
end
 
args[k] = v; -- save this parameter and its value
 
elseif not utilities.is_set (v) then -- for empty parameters
if not validate (k, config.CitationClass, true) then -- is this empty parameter a valid parameter
k = ('' == k) and '(empty string)' or k; -- when k is empty string (or was space(s) trimmed to empty string), replace with descriptive text
table.insert (empty_unknowns, utilities.wrap_style ('parameter', k)); -- format for error message and add to the list
end
-- crude debug support that allows us to render a citation from module {{#invoke:}} TODO: keep?
-- elseif args[k] ~= nil or (k == 'postscript') then -- when args[k] has a value from {{#invoke}} frame (we don't normally do that)
-- args[k] = v; -- overwrite args[k] with empty string from pframe.args[k] (template frame); v is empty string here
end -- not sure about the postscript bit; that gets handled in parameter validation; historical artifact?
end
end
if 0 ~= #empty_unknowns then -- create empty unknown error message
utilities.set_message ('err_param_unknown_empty', {
1 == #empty_unknowns and '' or 's',
utilities.make_sep_list (#empty_unknowns, empty_unknowns)
});
end
local url_param_t = {};


for k, v in pairs( args ) do
for k, v in pairs( args ) do
if 'string' == type (k) then -- don't evaluate positional parameters
if 'string' == type (k) then -- don't evaluate positional parameters
has_invisible_chars (k, v); -- look for invisible characters
has_invisible_chars (k, v);
end
has_extraneous_punc (k, v); -- look for extraneous terminal punctuation in parameter values
missing_pipe_check (k, v); -- do we think that there is a parameter that is missing a pipe?
args[k] = inter_wiki_check (k, v); -- when language interwiki-linked parameter missing leading colon replace with wiki-link label
 
if 'string' == type (k) and not cfg.url_skip[k] then -- when parameter k is not positional and not in url skip table
url_param_t[k] = v; -- make a parameter/value list for extraneous url check
end
end
end
end
 
return citation0( config, args)
has_extraneous_url (url_param_t); -- look for url in parameter values where a url does not belong
 
return table.concat ({
frame:extensionTag ('templatestyles', '', {src=styles}),
citation0( config, args)
});
end
end


 
return cs1;
--[[--------------------------< E X P O R T E D  F U N C T I O N S >------------------------------------------
]]
 
return {citation = citation};

Menu navigasi